Loading...
HomeMy WebLinkAbout40 Towne Center Cir - 95-002868 (1995) (Steak n Shake) (a) docsyo Two C&V& LS /C h,4 tL j ZONE CONTRACTOR ADDRESS DATE v 60 1 qs- - Li n /+r. (n -7E; PHONE # 90Y "' AO-/, " LOCATION ,IIAWw4 i ADDRESS PHONE # I V U PLUMBING CONTRACTOR \- - ADDRESS SUBDIVISION: ffaL;-- PERMIT #CL c _ JOB nf. - COST FEE $ STATE NO. l eC-6-34a3 (-O FEE $ O PHONE # qS--3 Q la ELECTRICAL CONTRACTOR FEE $)(, y ADDRESS PHONE # MECHANICAL CONTRACTOR - &26 4 FEE $ ADDRESS PHONE # MISCELLANEOUS CONTRACTOR ADDRESS SEPTIC TANK PERMIT NO. SOIL TEST REQUIREMENTS FINISHED FLOOR ELEVATION REQUIREMENTS ( ARCH"' .;TURAL APPROVAL DATE: LOT NO. BLOCK: SECTION: SQUARE FEET: 4(0 0 MODEL: Q OCCUPANCY CLASS: INSPECTIONS ITYPEDATEOKREJECTBY FEE $ ENERGY SECT. EPI: q5 - &j -,( I CERTIFICATE OF OCCUPANCY ISSUED # s1/ DATE: FINAL DATE / OWNER: ADDRESS: DATE: kk . " 1 • q S REASON FOR DISAPPROVAL: CONDITIONAL AGREEMENT: FIRE DEPARTMENT PUBLIC WORKS 64 UTILITIES ENGINEERI j--)(.ft co FIGURE N-14 HANDICAP SIGN AND PARKING SPACE STANDARDS 4" J 2" L 4^ 4" -' z" 4 FIGURE H-15 PASSENGER LOADING ZONES 20' MIN. r-- Ell WHITE 2r O.C. OF SANp090 City of Sanford, Florida HANDICAP SIGNIPARKING AND FIGURES N14 & Dept. of Engineering PASSENGER LOADING ZONES N-15 and Plannings tiote co`' s I_ 12" 250 FINE CITY ORD. 3211 NOTES 1. ALL LETTERS ARE 1' SERIES 'C', PER TCD. 2. TOP PORTION OF SIGN SHALL HAVE REFLECTORIZED (ENGINEERING GRADE BLUE BACKGROUND WITH WHITE REFLECTORIZED LEGENDANDBRDER. 3. BOTTOM PORTION OF SIGN SHALL HAVE A REFLECTORIZED (ENGINEERINGGRADE) WHITE BACKGROUND WITH BLACK OPAQUE LEGEND & BORDER. 4. FINE NOTIFICATION SIGN SHALL HAVE A REFLECTORIZED (ENGINEERINGGRADE) WHITE BACKGROUND WITH BLACK OPAQUE LEGEND $ BORDER. 5. ONE(1) SIGN REQUIRED FOR EACH PARKING SPACE. 6. INSTALLATION HEIGHT OF SIGN SHALL BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 24-23 OF THE MANUAL ON UNIFORM TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES (MUTCD). a+ F SgyFOgp City of Sanford, Florida w4 Dept. of Engineering and PlanningoFCOO FL A. D. 0. T. APPROVED) HANDICAP PARKING SIGNAjnGE' DATE STARTED:— 11_16_q5 CITY OF SANFORD. FLORIDA Request for Final Inspection for*. Certificate of Occupancy ADDRESS: 4Q //Y r _&4L_ 6,A, The Building Department has prepared a certificate of occupancy for the above location and is requesting a final inspection by your department. After your inspection, please come to the Building Department to sign -off on the Certificate of Occupancy, or submit a certificate of occupancy addendum if it has been denied. Your prompt attention will be appreciated. Thank you. 0 DISTRIBUTION: Engineering Department Fire lic Works rUtilities/Cross Connection Zoning DATE STARTED: ff l Q - 95 CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA Request for Final Inspection for'. d Certificate Of Occupancy ADDRESS: 216 A l6, The Building Department has prepared a certificate of occupancy for the above location and is requesting a final inspection by yourdepartment. After your inspection, please come to the Building Department tojsign -off on the Certificate of Occupancy, or submit a certificate of occupancy addendum if it has been denied. Your prompt attention will be appreciated. Thank you. 0 DISTRIBUTION: Engineering Department Fire public Works Utilities/Cross Connection Zoning l DATE STARTED: // —/& '- CITY OF SANFORD. FLORIDA Requbst for Final Inspection for*. Rerificate lzf Occupancy ADDRESS:. The Building Department has prepared a certificate of occupancy for the above location and is requesting a final inspection by yourdepartment. After your inspection, please come to the Building Department to sign -off on the Certificate of Occupancy, or submit a certificate of occupancy addendum if it has been denied. Your prompt attention will be appi-eciated. DISTRIBUTION: Engineering Department Fire Public Works Utilities/Cross Connection 96-ning 1 C9w 321\ J Thank you. 3c- . ` DATE STARTED: CITY OF SANFORD. FLORIDA Requ'esf for Final Inspection for. Rertific.ate Of Occupancy ADDRESS:. The Building Department has prepared a certificate of occupancy for the above location and is requesting a f inal inspection by yourdepartment. After your inspection, please come to the Building Department to sign -off on the Certificate of Occupancy, or submit a certificate of occupancy addendum if it has been denied. Your prompt attention will be appreciated. Thank you. I DISTRIBUTION: v-' gineering Department' C P4/ Fire Public Works Utilities/Cross Connection Zoning 0 CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA PERMIT NO. lL I ' DATE 10 a THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOLLOWING H.A.R.V. MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT: OWNER'S NAME SJeL ,K 0 s(nr,„k.e- ADDRESS OF JOB l7u, a771 MECHANICAL CONTR. " i ti IUIGkr,,e r-' RESIDENTIAL COMMERCIAL Subject to rules and regulations of Sanford mechanical code. NATURE OF WORK I Number II AMOUNT FUEL B.T.U. INPUT OUTPUT I II "v VALUATION APPLICATION FEE Master Mechanical COMPETENCY CARD NO. CITY OF SANFORD FIRE -DEPARTMENT FEES FOR SERVICES PHONE #: 407-322-4952 DATE: %U q PERMIT #: BUSINESS NAME: ADDRESS:,j,o, PHONE NUMBER:( ) PLANS REVIEW BURN PERMIT TANK PERMIT COMMENTS: AMOUNT TENT PERMIT REINSPECTION FIRE SYSTEM G Q 9 S % .+—• Fees must be paid to Sanford Building Department,,300 N. Park Avenue, Sanford, Florida. Phone # 330-5656. Proof of payment must be made to Sanford Fire Prevention befare any further services can take place. I certify that the above information is true and correct and that I will comply with all applicable codes nd r nan es of the C' y S of d, lorida. Q Sanford i e Prevention ApplicaInts Signature STAIR OF FLOIIIUA FH02021 OFFICE 01: 1111_ASUI1C11 DEPA111 MEN r 01- INSUI IANCE ] 1ALLAIIASl3EE. FL0III0A ' F.11t1; E11MPTHE Ir DEALCH LICEHUI-- 1 ;> 1111S CEATIFII_5 r11Ar1 "ASTE11 POUT CpnP/UIIA/FIUEMAS1En/"CKjNNIE PH04 Cf.)I1111N1= !.)It LANUU. FL 32t10J • UUALIFIE?: MCKINNIEpJ1:1'V"EY 11ns CUFIIR.11'0 wtrlt sl (iT°111F1 ('33*0011 FlAIDA 9TA7urESv AND "AS UIIALirlru runt TIIRTYPEANDCLASSSIIUWMIll:ltlall•11 ' - T0 Sr. HVICE , IIEPAIR i I NSrALL. Ult INSPECT ALL TYPES OF I'itL-C.PI(i1Nf:E11EU fill(; I:XTIN(llll!c11JHU SYSTEMS. E PAW. V. q l U 1 '!5 U7 U Il'1 G U(1J!iUt1 U:1I19 !i!i<iUl::ltlUUJ 1 7.!;. (IU 1 ' r11EASUnEi1 y' IllsunnttcE coMMlsslollril 19SIIE UAIF Irrc CI A99 rnu.• vc° ry^'- o.. ( ni'i•iii:niiuii 0 InKEB 91EEA I',EI eA UAI I I 1111E MAIISIIAL We k r; i: Yt ' I:;: Q• •' FAM a - Not QW r ti# f • :r : •:: ; •::: law 4•Y,i ! C J J yy::::• A reMaster MASTER PROTECTION CORPORATION 2804 Corrine Dr. , Orlando. FL 32803 • (407) 894-1671 • FAX (407) 898-9717 Mojo- October 24, 1995 C C) City of Sanford S-(Qa Ks Q P.O. Box 1788 ` Sanford, Florida 32772 RE: Steak N Shake 40 Town Center Sanford, Florida 32772 Dear Sir/Madame: Please use this letter as authorization for our employees listed below to pick up, drop off or pay for permits or plans. Chris Kessler Thank you, f McKinnie FireMaster M250-430-60-247 8580 Ft. Thomas way Orlando, Florida 32822 Sworn and subscribed before me this 1995. My commission expires: day of 646L( c_ , 4" Me-lllt—" a Notary Public R. MICHAEL KNEARi `"' •` ;' Notary Pubfic, State of Florida My Comm. expires MAY 9, 1998 No. CC372166 F1326 J JULY 27, 1995 TO WHOM IT MAY CONCERN: A Consolidated Products Company steak h Shake*, Inc. SUBJECT: STEAK 'N SHAKE - MERRITT ISLAND, FL 2990 West 71st Street Indianapolis. IN 46268 317) 293-5350 The following company will be installing fire suppression systems in our exhaust hoods at the above subject project: FireMaster 2804 Corrine Drive Orlando, FL 32803 CONTACT: Lorraine Johnson 407) 894-1671 We are authorizing them to acquire required permits in our behalf. Should you have any questions, or need any additional information, please don't hesitate to contact us. Thank you. Sincerely, Andy Burtner Construction Project Manager AB/1 Employers Self Insurers Fund P.O. Omwer 988 • Lake!anc, PL 33802-0988 • Te'epnone (813) 665-6060 or t-800-232-7648 (lerida) _ PAX (8t3) 666-1958 CERTI?ICATE 01' INSURANCE ISSUED TO: City of Sanford P.O. Box 1788 Sanford, Florida 32772 This Is to certify that Master Protecti.on Carp. dba Firemaster; Master Protection Corp. dba Fire-::aster/Fountain ?ire 3aulnment 520 Broadway 0650, Santa Monica, CA 90401 being subject to the provisions of the Florida 'Workers' Compensation Act, has secured the payment of the c=pensat:ion by 1.sur'_ng their risk with the Employers Self Insurers Fund COVERAGE NUMBER: 0830-09086 ZFFECTTVE DATE: Aaril 1, 1995 _ EXPIRATION DATr: Aaril 1, 1996 _ PZMARKS : Statutory -state of Florida Znployers Liability 300,000 (Each accident) S00,000 (Disease -Each Employee) S500,000 (Disease -policy Limit) This certificate is not a policy and of itself does not afford any insurance. Nothing contained in this certificate a)iall be construed as extending coverage not afforded by the policy shown above or as affording insurance to any insured not named above. 1014C ` August 25, 1995 Summit Consulting, inc., Administrator Date Employers Self Insurers Fund a 1/06/95 24' Hood i 2 FRONT VIEW t5 MO Rom+ pDn 15 M-F.R ,/DW BYM t5 DUirP SiAitON 0= SLgja Atifp 14* arm StRFIC-' ME&- ){ coat S1JRrrci ARU 1YWfA^1lR WYAICACU' E.: FR"MER "AOU E- R W MER 41CO I: I Clil- I 1AlxCL' rru t-u I 40' 23 1/4' 7' x7" 20 1/4" COLLAR l 16 lf4" 7 3/4' 8 1/2 8" DIA. r 20` ' I 4 3/8' 1.D. 4 o Q 2{ TOP VIEW Road B2 Aran_ R102 g C& —' c Aasn1 FaC2 3 Ga—' '; 1 S=1" on Haod Ste^ onIRood #2 Systems installed are Ansul R102 3/3 Gallon Fire Suppression Systems UL 300 Standa=- flood # 2 Ansul R102 3 Gallon 1- 2w nozzle Duct 1- 1 N nozzle Plenum 2- 245 nozzle :--vers Svstem Dti'_izes 7 _low Points opossible_ r.-- a- __ a-cces a= a -c,as ZZ--- down.UDc- i F-- j s1 SV. I rc_. 5, S _T.. beaC _L,,_G^(1_ •..Zy L . z-- f2- t. a._ __-_ s ..-- d. -l'. UZc:Y Sys tam ac ._:r-a v a K'-.. G U sea:. c . S vs 7emy_:^S -.a-! _s K•=cz z N-Dt S c c a-; _c - COe= Fire Protection special Fim EgL - Saim uld Sovica t0qEAR sion O^ ar' WA 2&X Coer+ e Dare OnWWCLF F= c caon as e4n7 Steak N Shake 40 Town Center Sanford,F1. 32771 4M aW- jM Hood 11 6" u4 318' I.D. 36 (-41L • ? A' GKIS 2C CFMLr CODQt Af3i6 AAEk 36 27 5/6 00"C k: AtrFk24 is,Co"C NE/Q Aim IF 1UMYAC llE HOBOM WMjACttiE HOW N0771 IDCATU& 35 I/7 S+OW AN;LE 24 23 I/7 iOP VIEW Hood #1 Ansul R102 3 Gallon 1-2W nozzle Duct 1-1N nozzle Plenum 3-290 nozzle Grills System Utilizes 9 Flow Points of 11 possible. DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Plying Roquiremerns — 3.0 Gallon System Th: za;wV , iiia z= ei me first drancn fine and the start df the last branch h- must not exceed 24 ft. (7.3 m). When the suotiy line is split. the combined taltoof bom Rigs of the simoy line (tram me start of true first brenen line to me star of the last branch fine) must not exceed 24 K (7.3 m). See Figure 74. 2. The total length of all branch fines must not exceed 36 tL 10. 9 rn. Sae Figure 74. 3. Use a 318 in. union to oonnedt the tank adaptor to the 318 in. supply fine. 4. A maximum of two nrmRis ere allowed per duet b. at fine. 5. The reouiremems of the foliowtng table must not be exceeded: DuG Plenum Appliance Reouiremsnat Su=ty Una Branch Una Branch Line Branch Line Pipe size 318 in. 3/8 in. 318 in. 318 in. Maximum Length 40 R 8 It. a tL 12 IL 122 m) (2.4 m) 12 m) 3.7 m) Maximum Rise 6 tL 4 It. 2 K 2 tL 1. 8 m) (12 in) 6 in) 6 in) Maximum 90• 9 4 Elbows a 6 Maximum Tees 1 2 1 a Maximum Flow 11 • a 2 4 Numbers ilww. i 1. 1 td ty. ww. w rye w. rq . m4 11 A w 111 2w oC .etL6 Iw It) VDI waasc wmwl. w, wl nl IM an.1 o s tt ltv. ws. w w.c t. w w lw w wr a.e e. owe w Annul R-102 Restaurant System (Standard UL 300 Listed) Training Program Design, Installation, Recharge and Maintenance Manual f Taw`; ] •IPA; j• `' This manual is intended for use with Ansul R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems. Those who install, operate, recharge, or maintain these fire sup- pression systems should read this entire manual. Specific sec- tions will be of particular interest depending upon one's responsibilities. Fire suppression systems are mechanical devices. They need periodic care. Maintenance is a vital step in the performance of your fire suppression system. As such it must be performed in accordance with NFPA 96 (Standard for the Installation of Equipment for the Removal of Smoke and Grease -Laden Vapors from Commercial Cooking Equipment) and NFPA 17A (Standard on Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems) by an authorized Ansul distributor. To provide maximum assurance that the fire sup- pression system will operate effectively and safely, maintenance must be conducted at six-month intervals, or earlier if the situa- tion dictates. Twelve-year maintenance must include agent tank hydrostatic testing. ANSUL, ANSUL AUTOMAN and ANSULEX are registered trademarks. SECTION I. GENERAL INFORMATION DESIGN AND APPLICATION UL LISTING DEFINITION OF TERMS II. SYSTEM DESCRIPTION TOTAL SYSTEM Single -Tank Double -Tank Multiple -Tank 111. SYSTEM COMPONENTS EXTINGUISHING AGENT ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY MECHANICAL) ANSULAUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ELECTRICAL) TANK -BRACKET ASSEMBLY TANK -ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY OEM RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY FOR OEM IN -CABINET USE ONLY) GAS CARTRIDGES NOZZLES METAL BLOW -OFF CAP CONDUIT OFFSET ASSEMBLY QUIK-SEAL" ADAPTOR COMPRESSION -SEAL" ADAPTOR HOOD SEAL" ADAPTOR ASSEMBLY DETECTORS PULLEY ELBOWS PULLEY TEE STAINLESS STEEL CABLE REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION MECHANICAL GAS VALVES ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES MANUAL RESET RELAY ELECTRICAL SWITCHES PRESSURE SWITCHES REGULATOR TEST KIT FUSIBLE LINK BURSTING DISC PAGES 1-1 — 1-2 1-1 1-1 1-1 — 1-2 2-1 — 2-2 2-1 2-1 2-1 2-2 3-1 — 3-13 3-1 3-1 3-1 3-2 3-2 3-2 3-3 3-3 3-3 — 3-8 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-10 3-10 3-11 3-11 3-11 3-11 3-11 3-12 3-12 3-12 3-12 3-13 3-13 TABLE OF CONTENTS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 SECTION IV. SYSTEM DESIGN NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS Duct Protection Electrostatic Precipitator Protection Plenum Protection Single Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow Split Vat Fryer Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection 2-Flow Single Nozzle Fryer Protection 3-Flow Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection 3-Flow Range Protection Griddle Protection Chain Broiler Protection Overhead Chain Broiler Protection Nieco Broiler with Catalytic Converter Protection Upright/Salamander Broiler Protection Electric Char -Broiler Protection Gas -Radiant Char -Broiler Protection Lava -Rock (Ceramic) Char -Broiler Protection Natural Charcoal Broiler Protection Alternate Ceramic/Natural Charcoal Char -Broiler Protection Mesquite Char -Broiler Protection Wok Protection Nozzle Application Chart TANK QUANTITY REQUIREMENTS System Variations ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS Actuation Gas Line — 6 Tanks Maximum Actuation Gas Line — 10 Tanks Maximum Expellant Gas Line DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS General Piping Requirements Supply and Branch Line Identification 1.5 Gallon System 3.0 Gallon System 6.0 Gallon Manifolded System PAGES 4-1 — 4-41 4-1 — 4-25 4-1 — 4-6 4-6 — 4-7 4-7 — 4-9 4-9 — 4-10 4-10.1 4-10.1 — 4-10.3 4-10.4 — 4-10.5 4-10.5 — 4-11 4-11 — 4-14 4-14.1 — 4-17 4-17 — 4-18 4-18 4-19 4-19 4-20 4-20 4-21 4-21 4-22 4-22 4-23 4-24 — 4-25.2 4-26 4-26 4-26 — 4-28 4-26 — 4-27 4-27 4-28 4-28 — 4-34.2 4-28 4-29 — 4-30 4-31 — 4-33 4-34 4-34.1 — 4.34.2 I TABLE OF CONTENTS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 SECTION PAGES SECTION PAGES IV. SYSTEM DESIGN (Continued) VI. TESTING AND PLACING IN 6-1 — 6-4 DETECTION SYSTEM 4-35 — 4-36 SERVICE REQUIREMENTS TESTING MANUAL PULL STATION 6-1 Detector Identification 4-35 TESTING MECHANICAL GAS 6-1 Detector/Pulley Elbow Quantity 4-35 VALVES Detector Placement Requirements 4-35 — 4-36 TESTING ELECTRICAL GAS 6-2 Detection Line Requirements 4-36 VALVES Fusible Link Selection 4-36 MANUAL PULL STATION 4-37 TESTING ELECTRIC SWITCH 6-2 REQUIREMENTS TESTING PRESSURE SWITCH 6-3 MECHANICAL GAS VALVE 4-37 TESTING DETECTION SYSTEM 6-4 REQUIREMENTS ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE 4-37 — 4-38 VII. RECHARGE AND RESETTING 7-1 — 7-4 PROCEDURES REQUIREMENTS Approvals 4-38 RECHARGE 7-1 — 7-3 PRESSURE SWITCH 4-38 RESETTING 7-3 — 7-4 REQUIREMENTS Resetting Remote Manual Pull 7-3 ELECTRICAL SWITCH 4-38 — 4-41 Station REQUIREMENTS Resetting Mechanical Gas 7-3 Shut -Off Valve V. INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS 5-1 — 5-26 Resetting Electrical Switch 7-4 Snap -Action) MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS 5-1 — 5-2.2 Resetting Electrical Gas Shut -Off 7-4 INSTALLING THE ACTUATION 5-3 — 5-6 Valve AND EXPELLANT GAS LINES Resetting Pressure Switch 7-4 General Piping Requirements 5-3 REPLACEMENT CARTRIDGE 7-4 Actuation Gas Line 5-3 — 5-4 Expellant Gas Line From 5-5 Vill. MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION 8-1 — 8-7 Regulated Release Assembly SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE 8-1 — 8-3 Expellant Gas Line From 5-5 EXAMINATION Regulated Actuator Assembly Actuation Gas Line From 101 5-6 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE 8-4 — 8-7 Remote Release(s) to EXAMINATION Regulated Actuators INSTALLING THE DISTRIBUTION 5-7 IX. APPENDIX 9-1 9-11 — PIPING SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE 9-1 — 9-3 General Piping Requirements 5-7 SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX 9-4 — 9-6.2 Piping Installation 5-7 PARTS LISTS 9-7 — 9-10 INSTALLING THE DETECTION 5-8 — 5-17 WARRANTY 9-11 SYSTEM Installing "Clip -on" Style Linkage 5-8 — 5-12 Scissors" Style Linkage 5-12 — 5-15 Installation Installing "Hinged" Style Linkage 5-15 — 5-17 INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL 5-18 — 5-20 PULL STATION INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS 5-20 — 5-23 VALVE INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS 5-23 — 5-24 VALVE INSTALLING ELECTRICAL 5-24 — 5-25 SWITCHES INSTALLING PRESSURE SWITCH 5-26 DESIGN AND APPLICATION The Ansul R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System is designed to provide fire protection for restaurant cooking appli- ances, hoods, and ducts. It is a pre-engineered group of mechan- ical and electrical components for installation by an authorized Ansul distributor. The basic system consists of an ANSUL AUTOMAN regulated release assembly which includes a regu- lated release mechanism and a liquid agent storage tank housed within a single enclosure. Nozzles, detectors, cartridges, liquid agent, fusible links, pulley tees, and pulley elbows are supplied in separate packages in the quantities needed for each fire sup- pression system arrangement. The system provides automatic actuation; or it can be actuated manually through a remote manual pull station. The gas or elec- trical supply to all protected appliances will be immediately shut off upon actuation of the system, using appropriate gas shut- off or electrical shut -down devices. Additional equipment includes: remote manual pull station, mechanical and electrical gas valves, pressure switches, and electrical switches for automatic equipment and gas line shut- off. Accessories can be added, such as alarms, warning lights, etc., to installations where required. The R-102 system suppresses fire by spraying the plenum area, the filters, cooking surfaces, and the exhaust duct system with a predetermined flow rate of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Sup- pressant. When the liquid agent is discharged onto a cooking appliance fire, it cools the grease surface, and reacts with the hot grease (saponification) forming a layer of soap -like foam on the surface of the fat. This layer acts as insulation between the hot grease and the atmosphere, thus helping to prevent the escape of combustible vapors. Exhaust fans in the ventilating system should be left on. The forced draft of these fans assists the movement of the liquid agent through the ventilating system, thus aiding in the fire sup- pression process. These fans also provide a cooling effect in the plenum and duct after the fire suppression system has been discharged. The system is UL listed with or without fan operation. It is also recommended that make up or supply air fans be shut down upon system actuation. Shutdown of fuel and power to all appliances located under protected ventilating equipment is required upon system actuation. UL LISTING The R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System has been tested and is listed by Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. as a pre- engineered system. These tests require extinguishment of fires which are initiated in deep fat fryers, griddles, char -broilers, upright broilers, chain -broilers, filters, plenum chambers, hoods, and ducts after pre -loading each appliance with a prescribed amount of cooking grease. Each fire is allowed to progress to maximum intensity before the fire suppression system is actuated. SECTION I — GENERAL INFORMATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 1-1 DEFINITION OF TERMS Actuation Gas Line: Piping from the ANSUL AUTOMAN Regu- lated Release Assembly which supplies nitrogen or carbon dioxide to the Regulated Actuator Assembly for multiple -tank system actuation. Agent Tank: A pressure vessel containing the liquid agent. ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical): An assembly which contains the regulated release mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose, solenoid, and electric switch within a metal enclosure. The enclosure contains knockouts to facilitate component hookups. ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Mechan- ical): An assembly which contains the regulated release mech- anism, agent tank, and expellant gas hose within a metal enclosure. The enclosure contains knockouts to facilitate com- ponent hookups. Authority Having Jurisdiction: The "authority having jurisdic- tion" is the organization, office, or individual responsible for approving" equipment, an installation, or a procedure. The phrase "Authority Having Jurisdiction" is used in a broad manner since jurisdictions and "approval" agencies vary as do their responsibilities. Where public safety is primary, the authority having jurisdiction" may be a federal, state, local, or other regional department or individual such as a fire chief, fire marshal, chief of a fire prevention bureau, labor department, health department, building official, electrical inspector, or others having statutory authority. For insurance purposes, an insurance company representative may be the "authority having jurisdic- tion." In many circumstances the property owner or his desig- nated agent assumes the role of the "authority having jurisdiction;" at government installations, the commanding officer or departmental official may be the "authority having jurisdiction." Blow -Off Cap: A cap which covers the end of the nozzle tip and prevents grease from plugging the nozzle orifice. Branch Line: The agent distribution piping which extends from the supply line to the nozzle(s). Bursting Disc: A disc installed in the tank adaptor which eliminates the siphoning of the agent up the pipe during extreme temperature variations. Cartridge: A sealed, steel pressure vessel containing nitrogen or carbon dioxide gas used to pressurize the agent tank. Cooking Appliance: Includes fryers, griddles, ranges, upright broilers, chain broilers, natural charcoal broilers, or char -broilers electric, lava rock, gas -radiant, or mesquite). Conduit Offset Assembly: A pre -formed piece of conduit which can be installed between the Ansul regulated release and the conduit to allow the wire rope for the detection, gas valve and remote manual pull station to be installed in a more convenient manner. SECTION I — GENERAL INFORMATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 1-2 DEFINITION OF TERMS (Continued) Detector: A device which includes the detector bracket, detector linkage, and fusible link used for automatic operation of the fire suppression system. Detector Linkage: A device used to support the fusible link. Distribution Piping: Piping which delivers the extinguishing agent from the tank to each discharge nozzle. See also Supply or Branch lines. Ducts (or Duct System): A continuous passageway for the transmission of air and vapors which, in addition to the contain- ment components themselves, may include duct fittings, plenums, and/or other items or air handling equipment. Electrostatic Precipitator: A device used to aid in the cleaning of the exhaust air. This device is normally installed at or near the base of the ventilation duct. Expellant Gas Line: Piping and/or hose which supplies the nitrogen or carbon dioxide gas from the regulated release assembly/regulated actuator assembly to each agent tank. Flow Number: Term used in system design to describe the flow capacity of each nozzle used to determine the quantity of tanks needed to cover a certain group of hazards. Fusible Links: A form of fixed temperature heat detecting device employed to restrain the operation of a mechanical control until its designed temperature is reached. Gas Valve: A device used to shut off the gas supply to the cooking equipment when the system is actuated. Gas Valve Air Cylinder: An air cylinder, located in the release mechanism, which operates pneumatically to mechanically unlatch a mechanical gas valve actuator, causing the gas valve to close upon system actuation. High Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between the nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected. Hood: A device provided for cooking appliances to direct and capture grease -laden vapors and exhaust gases. It shall be con- structed in a manner which meets the requirements of NFPA 96. Liquid Agent: A potassium -based solution used for the knock- down and suppression of fire. Low Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between the nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected. Maximum Length of Cooking Appliance: The maximum dimension, on any side, which may be protected by one nozzle. Maximum Piping: Specified length of piping and number of fit- tings which must not be exceeded for each system. Medium Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between the nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected. Minimum Piping: Minimum length of distribution piping required between the agent tank outlet and any nozzle protecting a griddle, range, or fryer. Nozzle: A device designed to deliver the liquid agent with a specific flow rate and stream pattern. Overlapping Protection: When two types of appliances, side by side, are protected as a common hazard. This protection requires the maximum hazard size to be limited to the listed size of the worst hazard. Plenum: The space enclosed by the filters and the portion of the hood above the filters. Pulley Elbow: A device used to change the direction of the wire rope which runs between: the regulated release mechanism and the detectors, the regulated release mechanism and the mechanical gas valve, and/or the regulated release mechanism and the remote manual pull station. Pulley Tee: A device used to change the direction of iwo wire ropes which run from the regulated release mechanism to two remote manual pull stations, or from two regulated release assemblies to a single mechanical gas valve. Regulated Actuator Assembly: An assembly which contains the regulator, pneumatic actuator, agent tank, and expellant gas hose within a metal enclosure. This assembly is used to pres- surize additional agent tanks in a multiple tank system. Regulated Release Mechanism: An enclosed device within the ANSUL AUTOMAN regulated release assembly which releases the expellant gas, activates alarms, and/or shuts off other devices when signaled automatically by a detector or manually with a remote pull station. Regulator: A device used to regulate the pressure from the nitrogen cartridge into the agent tank(s) when the system is actuated. Remote Manual Pull Station: A device which provides manual actuation of the system from a remote location. Salamander Broiler: A broiler very similar in design to the upright broiler. A salamander broiler is used for general broiling of meats and fish, toasting, and holding/warming foods. Most contain a removable grease drip tray. Supply Line: The agent distribution piping which extends from the agent tank outlet and serves as a manifold for the branch lines. Series Detector: Any detector located in -line between the regu- lated release assembly and the terminal detector. Terminal Detector: The last in a series of detectors, or the only detector used in a single -detector system. This detector is thus named because it is at the point at which the wire rope ends, or "terminates." There is only one terminal detector per detec- tion system. Transition: An extension of the hood or canopy which allows for the smooth transmission of gases, air, and vapors between the hood opening and the base of the ventilation duct. Vent Plug: A device used to prevent pressure build-up within the agent tank or agent distribution lines due to temperature fluctuations. TOTAL SYSTEM There are three types of R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems: - 1. Single -tank System 2. Double -tank System 3. Multiple -tank System The type of system required for the particular installation will be determined through the guidelines covered in "System Design." Additional equipment which may be required to com- plete the system design is explained in the "System Compo- nents" section. Additional devices covered are: remote manual pull stations, mechanical and electrical gas shut-off valves, elec- trical switches, and pressure switches. Single -Tank System The R-102 single -tank system is available with a stainless steel enclosure and consists of: 1. ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or Mechanical) 2. Nitrogen Cartridge and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge 3. ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 4. Discharge Nozzles 5. Detection Components 6. Additional Devices (As Required) The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing detec- tion system and additional equipment. Refer to "System Com- ponents" section for individual component descriptions. 1 SECTION II — SYSTEM DESCRIPTION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 2-1 Double -Tank System The R-102 double -tank system is available with a stainless steel enclosure and consists of: 1. ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or Mechanical) 2. Nitrogen Cartridge and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge 3. ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 4. Tank -Enclosure or Tank -Bracket Assembly 5. Discharge Nozzles 6. Detection Components 7. Additional Devices (As Required) The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing expel- lant piping, detection system, and additional equipment. The tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly is mounted separately but within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly expellant gas piping requirements to ensure simulta- neous actuation of the system. Refer to "System Components" section for individual component descriptions. FIGURE 2 SECTION 11 — SYSTEM DESCRIPTION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 2-2 REV. 1 TOTAL SYSTEM (Continued) Multiple -Tank System The R-102 multiple -tank system is available with a stainless steel enclosure and consists of: 1. ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or Mechanical) 2. Nitrogen Cartridge(s) and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge(s) 3. Regulated Actuator Assembly(ies) 4. ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 5. Tank -Enclosure or Tank -Bracket Assembly(ies) 6. Discharge Nozzles 7. Detection Components 8. Additional Devices (As Required) The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing actua- tion piping, expellant piping, detection system, and additional equipment. Each regulated actuator assembly is mounted separately but within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly actua- tion/expellant gas piping requirements to ensure simultaneous actuation of the system. The assembly contains the pneumatic actuator, regulator, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure plugs to facilitate installing expellant piping. Each tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly is mounted separately but within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly or regulated actuator assembly expellant gas piping requirements to ensure simultaneous actuation of the system. Refer to nent desci rnavnr- 13 EXTINGUISHING AGENT ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant (1.5 gallon — Part No. 79694 or 3.0 gallon — Part No. 79372) is a potassium -based solution designed for fast knock -down and suppression of grease -related fires. The agent is shipped in plastic containers which provide one complete tank charge. Agent storage life expectancy is twelve years. The distributor must record the batch numbers and date of shipment receipt to be filed with each instal- lation record. ANSULEX" LOW pH LIQUID FIRE SUPPRESSANT 3.0 GALLON 1.5 GALLON FIGURE 1 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY (MECHANICAL) The ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Mechanical Release Assembly (3.0 gallon — Part No. 79290 or 1.5 gallon — Part No. 79291) contains the regulated release mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing actuation piping; expellant piping; detection system; and additional equipment. This regu- lated release assembly is used in single, double, and multiple - tank systems and must be mounted to a rigid surface. The release mechanism can be used to interconnect both the actu- ation and expellant gas lines as required per system design. The regulator is designed to allow a constant flow of gas into the tank at 100 psi (690 kPa) when the system is actuated. In single, double, and multiple -tank systems, the provided expel- lant gas hose connects the agent tank to the bottom outlet of the regulator. In double and multiple -tank system configurations, the back outlet of the regulator is used as an expellant gas feed for one additional tank -enclosure or tank -bracket hookup. The enclosure contains the required knockouts to facilitate this con- nection. If a pressure switch is to be attached to the regulator, additional fittings are required. The tank is mounted within the enclosure. The tank contains an adaptor/tube assembly with a burst disc union. The burst disc helps prevent siphoning of the agent up the pipe due to signifi- cant temperature fluctuations in the area where the tank is located. The tank is mild steel and, under normal conditions, requires hydrostatic testing every twelve years. The agent tank is shipped uncharged and must be filled with 1.53 gallons (5.8 L) or 3.06 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant during installation. The detection and additional equipment required per system design are connected to the release mechanism. The enclosure contains knockouts to facilitate detection and additional hookups. The system can be actuated automatically or manually. Auto- matic actuation occurs when a fusible link within the detection system separates in a fire condition. Manual actuation of the system occurs when personnel pull on the remote manual pull station pull ring. SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-1 ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY MECHANICAL) AGENT TANI RELEASE MECHANISA ti I FIGURE 2 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY (ELECTRICAL) The ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Electrical Release Assembly 3.0 gallon Part No. 79292) is identical to the mechanical ver- sion except it contains a factory installed 120 VAC solenoid and electrical switch. The solenoid is used to provide electrical actuation of the release mechanism. The electric switch is used to protect the solenoid by opening the circuit to the solenoid once the system is fired. Additional electrical switches can be added as required for auto- matic equipment and gas shut-off accessories, as well as initiating audible and visual alarms. ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ELECTRICAL) AGENT TANK SWITCH SOLENOID FIGURE 3 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-2 TANK -BRACKET ASSEMBLY The Tank -Bracket Assembly (1.5 gallon — Part No. 78232 or 3.0 gallon — Part No. 78937) consists of an agent storage tank and mounting bracket. This assembly is used in double and multiple -tank systems and must be mounted to a rigid surface near the regulated release assembly or regulated actuator assembly that its expellant gas line will be connected to. The tank contains an adaptorttube assembly with a bursting disc. The bursting disc helps prevent agent leakage due to signifi- cant temperature fluctuations in the area where the tank is located. The tank is mild steel and, under normal conditions, requires hydrostatic testing every twelve years. The date of manufacture is stamped on the bottom of the tank. The tank is shipped uncharged and must be filled with 1.53 gallons (5.8 L) or 3.06 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant during installation. The tank bracket is designed for mounting the tank in a minimum amount of space. TANK -BRACKET ASSEMBLY TANK ADAPTOR/ 4SSEMBLY AGENT TANK TANK -ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY MOUNTING BRACKET FIGURE 4 The Tank -Enclosure Assembly (1.5 gallon — Part No. 78921 or 3.0 gallon — Part No. 78929) consists of an agent storage tank and mounting enclosure. This assembly is used in double and multiple -tank systems and must be mounted to a rigid surface near the regulated release or regulated actuator assembly its expellent gas line will be connected to. The tank contains an adaptorAube assembly with a bursting disc. The bursting disc helps prevent agent leakage due to signifi- cant temperature fluctuations in the area where the tank is located. The date of manufacture is stamped on the bottom of the tank. The tank is shipped uncharged and must be filled with 1.53 gallons (5.8 L) or 3.06 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant during installation. The tank -enclosure is designed for mounting the tank in a minimum amount of space. TANK ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY AGENT TANK MOUNTING ENCLOSURE REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY TANK ADAPTOR/ TUBE ASSEMBLY FIGURE 5 The Regulated Actuator Assembly (1.5 gallon — Part No. 79137 or 3.0 gallon — Part No. 79327) contains the regulator, pneu- matic actuator, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing expel- lant piping. This assembly is used in multiple -tank systems and must be mounted to a rigid surface. The regulator contains two outlets 1350 apart. One outlet is used to interconnect the expellant gas hose to the enclosed agent tank. The other outlet connects an expellant gas line to an addi- tional tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly. The regulator is designed to allow a constant flow of nitrogen into each agent tank connected (two tanks maximum) at 100 psi (690 kPa). The pneumatic actuator is designed to puncture the expellant gas cartridge seal upon receiving pressure from the regulated release assembly actuation piping. The agent tank is shipped uncharged and must be filled with 1.53 gallons (5.8 L) or 3.06 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppres- sant during installation. The tank is mounted and secured within the enclosure. The enclosure contains a knockout to facilitate distribution piping hookup. REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY AGENT TANK PNEUMATIC ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATOR FIGURE 6 OEM RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY (FOR OEM IN -CABINET USE ONLY) The OEM Release/Bracket Assembly, Part No. 79493, contains the same regulated release mechanism as the standard ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly. This release/bracket assembly can be installed in the fire cabinet horizontally or ver- tically. It contains all the necessary mounting and conduit holes needed to fully install the assembly. The agent tank is installed separately and need not be bracketed once it is piped and filled. MOUNTING RELEASE M' BRACKET MECHANISM-r REGULATOR FIGURE 7 GAS CARTRIDGES In Single -Tank System arrangements, the 1.5 gallon regulated release assembly requires an LT-20-R nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 7032) or a 101-10 carbon dioxide cartridge (Part No. 15850) and the 3.0 gallon regulated release assembly requires an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 5373) or a 101-20 carbon dioxide cartridge (Part No. 17492) to properly expel the contents of a single tank. In Double -Tank System arrangements (two 3.0 gallon tanks or one 3.0 gallon tank and one 1.5 gallon tank), the regulated release assembly requires a "double -tank" nitrogen cartridge Part No. 73022) or a 101-30 carbon dioxide cartridge (Part No. 15851) to properly expel the contents of two tanks simul- taneously. In Double -Tank System arrangements (two 1.5 gallon tanks), the regulated release assembly requires a LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge Part No. 5373) or a 101-20 carbon dioxide cartridge (Part No. 17492) to properly expel the contents of two tanks simul- taneously. In manifolded system arrangements (two 3.0 gallon tanks), if using a 3.0 gallon regulated release and a 3.0 gallon tank enclosure, the regulated release requires a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge, (Part No. 73022). If using a 3.0 gallon regu- lated actuator and a 3.0 gallon tank enclosure, the regulated actuator requires either a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 73022) or an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 29187). In Multiple -Tank System arrangements, cartridge sizes vary depending on the size of tanks, number of tanks, and arrange- ment of the actuation and expellant gas piping. SECTION III - SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 3-3 REV. 1 NITROGEN GAS CARTRIDGES T 1 7 7/8 IN. I 20 cm) 11 3/8 IN. 11 3/8 IN. UI 28.9 cm) 29.9 cm) 14 5l8 IN. 37.1 cm) 2112IN. 6.4 Cm) I 2 112 IN 4 3/16 IN. 6.4 cm) 10.6 cm)--- 3 9116 IN. 9 Cm) LT-20-R LT-30-R DOUBLE -TANK LT-A-101.30 CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE PART NO. 7032 PART NO. 5373 PART NO. 73022 PART NO. 29187 CARBON DIOXIDE CARTRIDGES 9 IN. 7 718 IN. 22.9 cm) ( 20 cm) 11 518 IN. 29.5 cm) i 2 IN. 2 1/2 IN.I 5.1 cm) (6.4 Cm) 1 2 1/2 IN. 6.4 cm) 101-10 101.20 101.30 CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE PART NO. 15850 PART NO. 17492 PART NO. 15851 FIGURE 8 NOZZLES There are fifteen types of discharge nozzles each designed to distribute the liquid agent in a uniform pattern throughout the hazard area: 1. 1 W Nozzle 9. 260 Nozzle 2. 1 N Nozzle 10. 290 Nozzle 3. 1/2N Nozzle 11. 2120 Nozzle 4. 3N Nozzle 12. 1 WS Nozzle 5. 2WH Nozzle 13. 1 NS Nozzle 6. 2W Nozzle 14. 1 NSS Nozzle 7. 230 Nozzle 15. 1 WSS Nozzle 8. 245 Nozzle In addition, where a regulated actuator assembly is required for Although these nozzles are similar in appearance and have cer- one agent tank, an LT-20-R nitrogen cartridge or a 101-10 carbon tain common parts, the tip of each nozzle is designed for adioxidecartridge (for 1.5 gallon tank) or an LT-30-R nitrogen car- specific application and must only be used in those areas. tridge or a 101-20 carbon dioxide cartridge (for 3.0 gallon tank) may be used within the regulated actuator assembly. SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-4 NOZZLES (Continued) 1 W Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 56927) The 1 W nozzle application is for ducts, plenums and overhead chain broilers. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chrome -plated and stamped with 1 W (See Figure 9). The (1) indicates that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number when determining system design. 5. This nozzle is also available in stainless steel (1 WSS) Part No. 417333. 1 W NOZZLE ASSEMBLY BODY STRAINERW 1 TIP O 1 CAP 1 to 1, FIGURE 9 IN Nozzle Assembly, (Part No. 56930) The 1 N nozzle application is for chain broilers, woks, electric char -broilers, lava rock char -broilers, natural charcoal broilers, and plenum coverage. This nozzle consists of four basic com- ponents: 1. ?he blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chrome -plated and stamped with 1 N (See Figure 10). The (1) indicates that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number when determining system design. 5. This nozzle is also available in stainless steel (1 NSS) Part No. 417332. Part is common to all nozzle assemblies. 1N NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 1N BODY STRAINER 1 TIP CAP 1 FIGURE 10 1/2N Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 56929) The 1/2N nozzle application is for upright broilers, salamanders, and electrostatic precipitators. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is brass and stamped with 1/2N. (See Figure 11). The (1 /2) indicates that this is a half -flow nozzle. A pair of these nozzles will equal one flow number when deter- mining system design. NOTICE Metal blow -off caps are not allowed with the 1/2N nozzle assembly. 1/2N NOZZLE ASSEMBLY T10 1/2N BODY STRAINER TIP CAP 1 Q 4 E i FIGURE 11 NOZZLES (Continued) 3N Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 76782) The 3N nozzle application is for mesquite char -broiler, lava rock ceramic) and natural charcoal char -broiler protection. This nozzle consists of three basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The nozzle body' mounting threads are 3/8-18 NPT male threads. 3. The nozzle tip is chrome -plated and stamped with 3N (See Figure 12). The (3) indicates that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers when deter- mining system design. 3N NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 3N BODY STRAIINER 1 TIP + O 1 1 CAP l FIGURE 12 2WH Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 78078) NOTICE Use 2WH nozzles on 1.5 gallon, 6 flow, duct and plenum protection only, Option 2. The 2WH Nozzle is for duct application (using the 1.5 gallon tank with Option 2 only) and consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease and other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer and contains 3/8-18 NPT male threads. 4. The nozzle tip is brass and stamped with 2WH (See Figure 13). The (2) stamped number indicates that this is a two flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. Pan is common to all nozzle assemblies. SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-5 2WH NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 2WH BODY STRAINER 4 1 TIP , CAP 1 c FIGURE 13 2W Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 56928) The 2W Nozzle is for duct application (all duct protection except Option 2, 1.5 gallon system) and consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease and other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer and contains 3/8-18 NPT male threads. 4. The nozzle tip is brass and stamped with 2W (See Figure 14). The (2) stamped number indicates that this is a two flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. 2W NOZZLE ASSEMBLY W BODY i STRAINER TIP I O CAP 1 00 FIGURE 14 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-6 NOZZLES (Continued) 230 Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 418117) 245 NOZZLE ASSEMBLY The 230 nozzle application is for fryer/high proximity. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chromed -plated and stamped with 230 (See Figure 15). The 2 indicates that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. 230 NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 230 BODY 1 STRAINERTIP1 CAP' 1 - 0 1 0 FIGURE 15 245 Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 418118) The 245 nozzle application is for fryer/low proximity, range/high proximity, and gas -radiant char -broiler. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chromed -plated and stamped with 245 (See Figure 16). The 2 indicates that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. Part is oommon to all nozzle assemblies. 245 BODY 1 STRAINER TIP CAP FIGURE 16 260 Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 418119) The 260 nozzle application is for range/medium proximity, and griddle/high proximity. This nozzle consists of four basic com- ponents: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chromed -plated and stamped with 260 (See Figure 17). The 2 indicates that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. 260 NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 260 BODY i STRAINERTIP - O1 OCAP ' 1 0 FIGURE 17 NOZZLES (Continued) 290 Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 418120) The 290 nozzle application is for range/low proximity, and griddle/medium proximity. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chromed -plated and stamped with 290 (See Figure 18). The 2 indicates that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when determining system design. 290 NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 290 BODY 1 STRAINIER 1 TIP + O CAP l FIGURE 18 2120 Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 418121) The 2120 nozzle application is for griddle/low proximity. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The strainer keeps foreign particles, which are larger than the nozzle orifice, from blocking the opening. 3. The nozzle body' houses the strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 NPT. 4. The nozzle tip is chromed -plated and stamped with 2120 See Figure 19). The 2 indicates that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers when deter- mining system design. Part is common to all nozzle assemblies. SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-7 2120 NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 2120 BODY 4 STRAINER TIP 1 O CAP FIGURE 19 1 WS Swivel Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 415567) The 1 WS nozzle has a swivel tip for ease of installation and aiming. The swivel nozzle can be used in any application that the 1 W nozzle is used on. The 1 WS nozzle application is for ducts, plenums, and overhead chain broilers. This nozzle con- sists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The nozzle body is chrome -plated and houses an internal strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 female NPT. 3. The nozzle tip is chrome -plated and stamped with 1 WS (See Figure 20). The (1) indicates that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number when determining system design. The tip can be rotated approximately 340 in any direction from nozzle centerline. 4. The tip retainer is chrome -plated and is necessary to secure the tip to the nozzle body to lock in the aiming angle. 1 WS NOZZLE ASSEMBLY 1WS BODY TIP I8— CAP d" — - TIP RETAINER 1 O / FIGURE 20 I SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-8 NOZZLES (Continued) INS Swivel Nozzle Assembly (Part No. 415566) The INS nozzle has a swivel tip for ease of installation and aiming. The swivel nozzle can be used in any application that the 1 N nozzle is used on. The 1 NS nozzle application is for chain broilers, electric char -broiler, lava rock char -broilers, natural char- coal broilers, and plenum coverage. This nozzle consists of four basic components: 1. The blow -off cap' keeps the orifice free of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent distribution. An integral retaining strap attaches the blow -off cap to the nozzle. 2. The nozzle body is chrome -plated and houses an internal strainer. The mounting threads on the body are 3/8-18 female NPT. 3. The nozzle tip is chrome -plated and stamped with 1 NS (See Figure 21). The (1) indicates that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number when determining system design. The tip can be rotated approximately 340 in any direction from nozzle centerline. 4. The tip retainer is chrome -plated and is necessary to secure the tip to the nozzle body to lock in the aiming angle. Part is common to all nozzle assemblies. Nozzle Identification Chart Nozzle Nozzle Tip Nozzle Nozzle Type Part No. Stamping Flow No. 1 W Nozzle 56927 1 W 1 1 WSS Nozzle 417333 1 W 1 1 N Nozzle 56930 1 N 1 1 NSS Nozzle 417332 1 N 1 1/2N Nozzle 56929 1/2N 1/2 3N Nozzle 76782 3N 3 2W Nozzle 56928 2W 2 2WH Nozzle 78078 2WH 2 INS Nozzle 415566 INS 1 1 WS Nozzle 415567 1 WS 1 230 Nozzle 418117 230 2 245 Nozzle 418118 245 2 260 Nozzle 418119 260 2 290 Nozzle 418120 290 2 2120 Nozzle 418121 2120 2 INS SWIVEL NOZZLE ASSEMBLY INS BODY TIP 6 CAP V o TIP RETAINER 0 Nozzle Identification Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Stainless Steel Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Stainless Steel Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Brass Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Brass Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Brass Tip Chrome -Plated Body, Tip Retainer and Tip Chrome -Plated Body, Tip Retainer and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip Chrome -Plated Body and Tip FIGURE 21 METAL BLOW -OFF CAP Two types of metal blow -off caps are available as options to the standard rubber caps. The metal cap can be used in unusually high heat conditions, generally over 400° F (204° C). The metal blow -off cap is attached to the nozzle by means of a stainless steel wire which prevents it from falling into the appliance during discharge. Shipping Assembly Part No. 79745 contains 10 metal blow -off caps for use on standard, non -swivel nozzles and Ship- ping Assembly Part No. 415568 contains 10 metal blow -off caps for use on swivel nozzles. NOTICE If metal blow -off caps are required for upright broiler protection, use (2) two 1 N nozzles (Part No. 56930) instead of 1/2N nozzles. STAINLESS STEEL WIRE METAL CAP FIGURE 22 CONDUIT OFFSET ASSEMBLY The conduit offset assembly, Part No. 79825, is used to change direction of the wire rope on detection, mechanical gas valve, and remote pull station lines. The conduit offset assembly can only be used in the area where the conduit attaches to the regu- lated release assembly. When using the conduit offset assembly, the maximum number of pulley elbows is still allowed. SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-9 OUIK-SEAL" ADAPTOR The "Ouik-Seal" adaptor is a listed mechanical bulkhead fitting that produces a liquid -tight seal around both distribution piping and detection conduit which runs through restaurant hoods and ducts. The "Ouik-Seal" adaptor accepts threaded pipe or con- duit. The adaptor is available for 1/4 in. (Part No. 78195), 3/8 in. (Part No. 77284), 1 /2 in. (Part No. 77286), or 3/4 in. (Part No. 77288) pipe or conduit sizes. When using with EMT conduit, a conduit connector must be installed in each end of the adaptor. ADAPTOR BODY GASKET LOCKWASHER NUT FIGURE 24 COMPRESSION -SEAL" ADAPTOR This adaptor is a mechanical bulkhead fitting that produces a liquid -tight seal around pipe and conduit when installing distri- bution piping and detection conduit through restaurant hoods and ducts. The "Compression -Seal" adaptor is a straight - through design requiring no cutting or threading of conduit or pipe. The adaptor is available for pipe sizes of 1/4 in. (Part No. 79148), 3/8 in. (Part No. 79150), 1/2 in. (Part No. 79146), and EMT conduit size of 1/2 in. (Part No. 79152).' COMPRESSION NUT f ADAPTOR BODY GASKET LOCKWASHER NUT Wu " FIGURE 25 COUPLING HOOD SEAL" ADAPTOR ASSEMBLY This adaptor, shipping assembly Part No. 79768, is a mechan- CONDUIT ical bulkhead fitting that produces a liquid -tight seal around 1/2 OFFSET in. EMT conduit when installing the detection line through res- taurant hoods and ducts. The adaptor accepts a high tempera- ture pulley elbow and, when used, correctly positions the elbow or conduit in line with the conduit adaptor hole in the detector bracket. The "Hood Seal" eliminates the need for multiple CONDUCT CONNECTOR elbows when penetrating the top of a hood when installing the detection line. FIGURE 23 SEAL NUT SEAL ADAPTOR WASHERBODYLi111 PULLEY ELLBOT0)rr__:; GASKET NOT PART OF ASSEMBLY) FIGURE 26 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-10 DETECTORS The detector consists of three basic components: the bracket, linkage, and fusible link. (Fusible links are not included and must be ordered separately.) The bracket holds the entire assembly to the mounting surface. The linkage is used to support the fusible link. The fusible link is designed to separate at a specific temperature and release the wire rope, thereby actuating the regulated release mechanism. There are three styles of detectors available: the clip -on style, the hinged style, and the scissor style. The clip -on style allows the wire rope to be strung completely through the detection system conduit and brackets first and the detector linkage assemblies are then clipped on later. The hinged style detector requires the wire rope to be strung to the detector bracket, and then "threaded" through the linkage assembly before continuing to the next detector bracket. The scissor style allows the wire rope to be strung completely through the detection system conduit and brackets first and the detector linkage assemblies are then clipped on later. Each style of detector consists of two types of assemblies: The Terminal Detector (Part No. 56838, 15375, or 417368) includes a test link and is placed last in a series of detectors. This detector is sometimes referred to as the end -of -line detector and is thus named because it is at the point at which the wire rope "terminates," or is anchored at the detector bracket. Only one terminal detector is required per detection system. The Series Detector (Part No. 56837, 15373, or 417369) is any detector located in -line between the regulated release assembly and the terminal detector. When using Part No. 56837 and 56838 style detectors, a total of 12 detectors can be in one detection system: 11 series detectors, Part No. 56837 and 1 terminal detector, Part No. 56838. When using Part No. 15373 and 15375 style detectors, a total of 5 detectors can be in one detection system: 4 series detectors, Part No. 15373 and 1 terminal detector, Part No. 15375. When using Part No. 417368 and 417369 style detectors, a total of 15 detectors can be in one detection system: 14 series detectors, Part No. 417369 and 1 terminal detector, Part No. 417368. CLIP -ON STYLE - PART NO. 56837 AND 56838 LINKAGE BRACKET FUSIBLE L/INK f MINDED STYLE - PART NO. 15373 AND 15375 SCISSOR STYLE - PART NO. 417368 AND 417369 BRACKET FIGURE 27 PULLEY ELBOWS There are two types of pulley elbows used to change the direc- tion of the wire rope by 900. Ansul recommends for tempera- tures not in excess of 700 OF (371 °C). Part No. 415670 has socket ends with set screws for 1/2 in. conduit, and Part No. 45771 has compression ring ends also for 1/2 in. conduit. PART NO. 415670 PART NO. 45771 mom FIGURE 28 PULLEY TEE The Pulley Tee (Part No. 15342) is used to change the direction of two wire ropes by 900. It must be used in areas where the temperatures are within the range of 32 OF to 130 OF (0 °C to 54 °C). Pulley tees can be used in mechanical gas valve actua- tion lines and remote manual pull station lines. Pulley tees cannot be used within a detection line. Pulley tees can only be used to operate one gas valve from two ANSUL AUTOMAN Releases. FIGURE 29 STAINLESS STEEL CABLE The 1/16 in. stainless steel cable is run from the terminal detector, through conduit, all series detectors and pulley elbows, and into the regulated release mechanism trip lever. When any fusible link separates, the tension on the cable is relaxed, and the trip lever actuates the regulated release mechanism. The cable can also be used for mechanical gas valves and remote manual pull stations. The cable is available in 50 ft. (15 m) (Part No. 15821) and 500 ft. (152.4 m) (Part No. 79653) lengths. REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION The remote manual pull station (Part No. 4835, Part No. 54011, or Part No. 415255) is required for manual actuation of the regu- lated release assembly. The remote manual pull station should be mounted at a point of egress and positioned at a height deter- mined by the authority having jurisdiction. PART NO. 4835 WITHOUT CABLE) PART NO. 54011) PART NO. 415255 WITH 50 FT. OF CABLE) (WITHOUT CABLE) 1 METAL STAMPED PLASTIC MOLDED FIGURE 30 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-11 MECHANICAL GAS VALVES The mechanical gas valves are designed to shut off the flow of gas to the appliances upon actuation of the regulated release assembly. The valves are available in sizes of 3/4 in., 1 in., 1 1/4 in., 1 1/2 in., and 2 in. Ansul style; and 2 1/2 in. and 3 in. Asco style. The valves are rated for natural and LP gas. Both styles are UL Listed. Maximum Part Operating No. Description Pressure 55598 3/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (69 kPa) 55601 1 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (69 kPa) 55604 1 1/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (69 kPa) 55607 1 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (69 kPa) 55610 2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (69 kPa) 25937 2 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (34.5 kPa) 25938 3 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (34.5 kPa) FIGURE 31 ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES The electrical gas valves are designed to shut off the flow of either natural or LP gas to the appliances upon actuation of the regulated release assembly. The valves are available in sizes of 3/4 in., 1 in., 1 1/2 in., 2 in., and 3 in.. The valve is held open by an energized solenoid and upon system actuation, the switch contacts in the regulated release assembly open, thus de - energizing the circuit to the gas valve solenoid, causing the valve to close. Valves are available in 120 VAC and are UL Listed. Maximum Part Operating No. Description Pressure 13707 3/4 in. Solenoid Gas Valve 2 psi (13.8 kPa) ASCO) 13708 1 in. Solenoid Gas Valve 1 psi (6.9 kPa) ASCO) 13709 1 1/2 in. Solenoid Gas Valve 25 psi (172 kPa) ASCO) 13710 2 in. Solenoid Gas Valve 25 psi (172 kPa) ASCO) 17643 3 in. Solenoid Gas Valve 5 psi (34.5 kPa) ASCO) FIGURE 32 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-12 MANUAL RESET RELAY The manual reset relay is required when using an electrical gas valve shut-off system. After the electric gas valve has closed, either due to system actuation or power failure, the valve can not be re -opened, allowing gas to flow, until the reset relay button Is manually pressed, re -energizing the circuit. The reset relay is available 120 VAC. The manual reset relay is also recom- mended for electrical shut down. I ELECTRICAL SWITCHES FIGURE 33 The electrical switches are intended for use with electric gas valves, alarms, contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric power shut-off devices and other electrical devices that are designed to shut off or turn on when the system is actuated. The switches are rated for 15 amp 1 /3 hp, 125 or 250 VAC, with 1/2 amp at 125 VDC and 1/4 amp at 250 VDC. The switches are available in SPDT (Part No. 15549), DPDT (Part No. 32222), 3PDT (Part No. 415868) and 4PDT (Part No. 32220) models. FIGURE 34 PRESSURE SWITCHES The pressure switch is a pneumatically operated electrical switch intended for use with electric gas valves, alarms, contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric power shut-off devices, and other electrical devices that are designed to shut off or turn on when the fire suppression system is actuated. The switches are rated at 20 amp, 125, 250, or 480 VAC - with 10 amp at 125 VAC "L" 1 hp-115 VAC, 2 hp-230 VAC, 1/2 amp at 125 VDC, 1/4 amp at 250 VDC, and are available in SPDT or DPDT models. The switch enclosure contains an external reset button for con- venient resetting. FIGURE 35 REGULATOR TEST KIT The Test Kit Assembly (Shipping Part No. 56972) is required to test the regulator setting and nitrogen flow during 12-year maintenance examinations. This will ensure that the regulator is functioning properly. rnaURE 36 FUSIBLE LINK In order to determine the normal operating temperature at the fusible link location, utilize a maximum registering thermometer Part No. 15240), temperature tape or other accurate thermometer. O O TEMPERATURE RATING L STAMPED ON FUSIBLE OLINK BODY CA K STYLE ML STYLE 500 °F (260 "C) ONLY FIGURE 37 Select correct UL Listed fusible link(s) for installation in detector(s) according to the temperature condition chart below: To Be Used Where Fusible Link Temperature Temperature Does Part No. Rating Not Exceed 415739 165 OF 74 °C) 100 OF (38 °C) 415740 212 OF 100 °C) 150 OF (66 °C) 415741 280 OF 138 °C) 225 OF (107 °C) 415742 360 OF 182 °C) 290 OF (143 °C) 415743 450 OF 232 °C) 360 OF (182 °C) 56816 500 OF 260 °C) 400 OF (204 °C) BURSTING DISC The R-102 Bursting Disc is installed in the tank adaptor assembly. The bursting disc eliminates the siphoning of the agent up the pipe during extreme temperature variations. The bursting discs are available in packs of 10, Part No. 417911. 5 FIGURE 38 SECTION III — SYSTEM COMPONENTS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 3-13 SYSTEM DESIGN One of the key elements for restaurant fire protection is a cor- rect system design. This section is divided into ten sub -sections: Nozzle Placement Requirements, Tank Quantity Requirements, Actuation and Expellant Gas Line Requirements, Distribution Piping Requirements, Detection System Requirements, Manual Pull Station Requirements, Mechanical Gas Valve Require- ments, Electrical Gas Valve Requirements, Electrical Switch Requirements, and Pressure Switch Requirements. Each of these sections must be completed before attempting any instal- lation. System design sketches should be made of all aspects of design for reference during installation. NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS This section gives guidelines for nozzle type, positioning, and quantity for plenum, duct, and individual appliance protection. This section must be completed before determining tank quan- tity and piping requirements. Duct Protection The R-102 system uses several different duct nozzles depending on the size of duct being protected. 1. 1 W Nozzle (Part No. 56927) — 1.5 Gallon and 3.0 Gallon Systems: The R-102 systems, both 1.5 gallon and 3.0 gallon, use the 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) for duct protection of 27 in. (68.6 cm) perimeter or less or 8.5 in. (21.6 cm) diameter or less. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 W, indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and is to be counted as one flow number. Single Nozzle (One Flow Number) Duct Protection: One 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) will protect ducts with a maximum perimeter of 27 in. (68.6 cm) or a maximum diameter of 8.5 in. (21.6 cm). The nozzle must be installed 2-8 in. (5-20 cm) into the center of the duct opening and positioned as shown in Figure 1. 2-8 IN. 5 — 20 cm) FIGURE 2 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-1 Single Nozzle (One Flow Number) Transition Protection: One 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) will protect transitions where the perimeter of 27 in. (68.6 cm) or the diameter of 8.5 in. (21.6 cm) or less begins within that transition. The nozzle must be placed in the center of the transi- tion opening where the maximum perimeter or diameter begins as shown in Figures 2 and 3. DUCT Al - MODULE PERIMETER NOT MORE THAN TRANSITION 27 IN. (68.6 cm) FIGURE 2 FIGURE 3 NOTICE A 2WH nozzle must be substituted for a 2W nozzle for any installation using Option 2 of the 1.5 gallon system coverage (6 flow duct and plenum protection only). 2. 2W Nozzle (Part No. 56928): The R-102 System, uses the 2W nozzle (Part No. 56928) for duct protection of 75 in. (190.5 cm) perimeter or less, or 24 in. (61 cm) diameter or less. The nozzle tip is stamped with 2W, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-2 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Duct Protection (Continued) The 1 W and 2W nozzles will protect the following: 3. Single Nozzle (2W) Duct Protection: One 2W nozzle will protect ducts with a maximum perim- eter of 75 in. (190.5 cm) or a maximum diameter of 24 in. 61 cm). The nozzle must be installed 2-8 in. (5-20 cm) into the center of the duct opening and positioned as shown in Figure 4. 2-8 IN. 5-20 cm) FIGURE 4 4. Single Nozzle (2W) Transition Protection: One 2W nozzle will protect transitions at the point where the perimeter of 75. in. (190.5 cm) or the diameter of 24 in. 61 cm) or less begins within that transition. The nozzle must be placed in the center of the transition opening where the maximum perimeter or diameter begins as shown in Figures 5 and 6. DUCT I MODULE PERIMETER NOT MORE THAN TRANSITION 75.IN. (190.5 cm) FIGURE 5 MODULE DIAMETER NOT MORE THAN 24 IN. (61 cm) DUCT t TRANSITION FIGURE 6 5. Dual -Nozzle Duct Protection: Two 2W nozzles will protect ducts with a maximum perim- eter of 150 in. (381 cm) or a maximum diameter of 48 in. 122 cm). The nozzles must be installed 2-8 in. (5-20 cm) into the duct opening and positioned as in Figure 7. i i 1/2 DUCT DUCT LENGTH 1/4 LENGTH DUCT LENGTH FIGURE 7 NOTICE In installations where a UL listed damper assembly is employed, the duct nozzle can be installed beyond the 8 in. (20 cm) maximum, to a point just beyond the damper assembly that will not interfere with the damper. Exceeding the maximum of 8 in. (20 cm) in this way will not void the UL listing of the system. NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Duct Protection (Continued) 6. Dual -Nozzle Transition Protection: Two 2W nozzles will protect transitions with a maximum perimeter of 150 in. (381 cm). The transition area must be divided where two equally sized modules begin within that transition. The nozzle must be placed in the center of the transition opening where the maximum module perimeter begins as shown in Figure 8. FIGURE 8 7. Dual -Nozzle Duct Protection (3 Flow Numbers): Rectangular ducts larger than 75 in. (191 cm) perimeter, up to a maximum of 102 in. (260 cm) perimeter, (diameters larger than 24 in. (61 cm), up to 32 in. (81 cm) diameter) can be protected with a combination of one 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) and one 2W nozzle (Part No. 56928). Each nozzle must be installed on its own duct branch line and positioned 2-8 in. (5-20 cm) into the center of the duct. See Figure 9. l SUPPLY LINE BRANCH LINE FIGURE 9 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-3 To correctly locate the nozzles in the duct, the longest side of the duct must be divided into four equal modules. See Figure 10. FIGURE 10 The 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) is then centered in one of the outside modules. See Figure 11. 1W NOZ2 CENTERE[ IN DUCT IN MODULE IN MODULE FIGURE 11 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-4 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Duct Protection (Continued) 7. (Continued) The 2W nozzle (Part No. 56928) is then centered in the remaining three modules. See Figure 12. CENTERED IN MODULE DI OF R , UUdETER \ 1W NOZZLE Y CENTERED \ IN DUCT 314 OF LONGEST SIDE DIAMETER 2W NOZZLE CENTERED IN MODULE LONGEST SIDE FIGURE 12 The nozzles must be positioned on the same centerline, par- allel to the longest side. See Figure 13. L,.4 PARALLEL TO LONGEST SIDE FIGURE 13 8. Triple -Nozzle Duct Protection (5 Flow Numbers): NOTICE When protecting the duct with a 1.5 gallon system using this type of protection, no appli- ance branch lines are allowed on the 1.5 gallon system. Rectangular/square ducts larger than 150 in. (381 cm) perimeter, up to a maximum of 177 in. (450 cm) perimeter, may be protected with a combination of one 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) and two 2W nozzles (Part No. 56928). Each nozzle must be installed on its own duct branch line and positioned 2-8 in. (5-20 cm) into the center of the duct. See Figure 14. BRANCH LINE 4.,'.Nc, SUPPLY LINE FIGURE 14 To determine if this type of protection can be used, first divide the longest side of the duct in half. See Figure 15. IGEST SIDE FIGURE 15 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Duct Protection (Continued) 8. (Continued) At the halfway point, center a module 13.5 in. (34 cm) wide. See Figure 16. CEN' IN DI 34.4 cm) FIGURE 16 Next, check the diagonal dimension of the two remaining modules to make certain that the maximum diagonal dimen- sion of 35.5 in. (85 cm) is not exceeded. Both diagonal dimensions should be the same. Make this check by meas- uring from one corner of the module to the opposite corner. See Figure 17. 1 W NOZZLE NOT TO EXCEED 35.5 IN. (90.2 cm) 112 OF LONGEST SIDE 6 3/4 NOT TO EXCEED (17.2 cm) 35.5 IN. (90.2 cm) LONGEST SIDE 13 1/2 IN. 34.4 cm) FIGURE 17 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-5 If this measurement exceeds 35.5 in. (85 cm), triple nozzle coverage cannot be used. The requirements for "Multiple. - Nozzle Duct Protection" (using all 2 flow nozzles) must then be followed. If the diagonal dimension of 35.5 in. (85 cm) has not been exceeded on either of the two outside modules, then a 1 W nozzle (Part No. 56927) can be located in the center of the 13.5 in. (34 cm) wide center module and a 2V1/ nozzle (Part No. 56928) can be centered in each of the two outside modules. See Figure 18. 2W NOZZLE 1 W NOZZLE I IIIF 2W NOZZLE DOUF2WIDTH 1/2 OF LONGEST SIDE LONGEST SIDE 1/2 MODULE WIDTH 6 3/4 IN. 17.2 cm) FIGURE 18 The nozzles must be positioned on the same centerline, par- allel to the longest side. See Figure 19. Y LINE PARALLEL TO LONGEST SIDE FIGURE 19 Triple -nozzle duct protection (5 flow numbers) is limited to rectangular or square ducts only. This application cannot be used with round ducts. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-6 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Duct Protection (Continued) 9. Multiple -Nozzle Duct Protection: For ducts larger than 150 in. (254 cm) perimeter, the total perimeter of the duct must be divided by 75. If the answer contains a decimal (or fraction), it must be rounded -up to the nearest whole number. This answer signifies the number of equally -sized modules in which the duct must be divided. The diagonal dimension of each module must not exceed 35.5 in. (90.2 cm). If diagonal dimension is exceeded, addi- tional module divisions must be added until the diagonal dimension is not exceeded. A nozzle must then be centered in each module. Example: Figure 20 shows a duct opening of 270 in. (686 cm) perimeter. By dividing 270 in. (686 cm) by 75, it is determined that the duct must be divided into 4 equally -sized modules. Because the diagonal dimension of each module is 33.54 in. (85.2 cm), it is within the maximum limit of 35.5 in. (90.2 cm) and therefore acceptable as shown in Figure 21.One nozzle is then centered in each module as'shown in Figure 22. 15 p rMAVI-S< <W 33.IN. 85.22 em) K 33.54 IN. 30 IN. 85.2 em) ( 76.3 cm) 33.54 IN. 30 IN. 85.2 cm) (76.3 cm) 7jM N. 30 IN. m) (76.3 cm) u 30 IN 15 IN. Y (76.3 cm) 38 cm) FIGURE 21 rnawRE 22 The chart below shows the maximum protection available from each duct nozzle. Part 3.0 Gallon 1.5 Gallon Description No. System System 1 W Nozzle 56927 Maximum Maximum 27 in. (69 cm) 27 in. (69 cm) Perimeter Perimeter 2W Nozzle 56928 Maximum Maximum 75 in. (191 cm) 75 in. (191 cm) Perimeter Perimeter 2WH Nozzle 78078 Maximum 75 in. (191 cm) Perimeter Electrostatic Precipitator Protection Some restaurant ventilating ducts have an electrostatic precipi- tator installed at or near the base. These precipitators are used to aid in the cleaning of exhaust air. Normally electrostatic precipitators do not require protection but should the "authority having jurisdiction" require protection, use the following guidelines. Ducts with precipitators located at or near the base can be pro- tected using duct nozzle(s) above the precipitator and 1/2N nozzle(s) (Part No. 56929) for the precipitator. One 1 /2N nozzle must be used for each cell being protected. This nozzle tip is stamped with 1/2N, indicating that it is a 1/2-flow nozzle and must be counted as 1/2 flow number. When protecting ducts equipped with precipitators, the duct nozzle(s) must be installed above the precipitator and aimed to discharge downstream. If the area above the precipitator is a duct, the nozzle(s) must be positioned according to duct pro- tection guidelines. If the area above the precipitator is a transi- tion, the transition guidelines must be followed. See Figure 20. NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Electrostatic Precipitator Protection (Continued) The 1/2N nozzle (Part No. 56929) must be centered 10 to 26 in. (25 to 66 cm) below the precipitator and aimed to discharge at the center of each precipitator cell. However, if it is physi- cally impossible to mount the nozzle at 10 to 26 in. (25 to 66 cm) due to precipitator placement, the nozzle may be mounted closer than 10 in. (25 cm). See Figure 23. SEE DUCT OR TRANSITION DUCT PROTECTION NOZZLE t PRECIPITATOR I 10.26 IN.* 25-66 cm) NOZZLE FOR PRECIPITATOR PROTECTION IF PHYSICALLY IMPOSSIBLE AT 10 TO 26 IN. (25 TO 66 cm), NOZZLE MAY BE MOUNTED CLOSER THAN 10 IN. (25 cm). FIGURE 23 Plenum Protection The R-102 system uses the 1 W Nozzle (Part No. 56927) or the 1 N Nozzle (Part No. 56930) for plenum protection. The 1 W nozzle tip is stamped with 1 W and the 1 N nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N, indicating they are both one -flow nozzles and must be counted as one flow number each. 1 W NOZZLE — PART NO. 56927 One 1 W nozzle will protect 4 linear feet (1.2 m) of plenum. The maximum distance from the end of the hood to the first and last nozzle must be no more than 2 ft. (.6 m). After the first nozzle, any additional nozzles must be positioned at a maximum of 4 ft. (1.2 m) apart down the entire length of the plenum. The plenum width must not exceed 4 ft. (1.2 m). (The 1 W nozzle can be used on single or V-bank filter arrangements.) See Figure 24. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-7 2 FT. 6 m) MAXIMUM 4 Fr. (1.2 m) MAXIMUM FIGURE 24 When protecting plenums with the 1 W nozzle, two options of coverage are available: Option 1: The 1 W nozzle must be on the center line of the single or "V" bank filter and positioned within 1-20 in. (2.5-51 cm) above the top edge of the filter. See Figure 25. 20 IN. (51 cm) MAXIMUM 1 IN. (2.5 cm) MINIMUM 20 IN. (51 cm) MAXIMUM 1 IN. (2.5 cm) MINIMUM FIGURE 25 Option 2: The 1 W nozzle must be placed perpendicular, 8-12 in. (20-30 cm) from the face of the filter and angled to the center of the filter. The nozzle tip must be within 2 in. (5 cm) from the perpendicular center line of the filter. See Figure 26. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-8 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Plenum Protection (Continued) 4 IN. 10 cm) NOZZLE TIP - MUST BE WITHIN THIS AREA 12 IN. (30 cm) MAXIMUM e IN. (20 cm) MINIMUM FIGURE 26 1 N NOZZLE — PART NO. 56930 One 1N nozzle will protect 8 linear feet (2.4 m) of single filter bank plenum or two 1 N nozzles will protect 8 linear feet (2.4 cm) of "V" bank plenum. In either application, the nozzle(s) must be mounted in the plenum, 2 to 4 in. (5 to 10 cm) from the face of the filter, centered between the filter height dimension, and aimed down the length. The filter height must not exceed 20 in. (51 cm). See Figure 27. 2-4 IN. 5-10 cm) a FT. (2.4 m) MAXIMUM 20 IN. (51 cm) MAXIMUM 2-4 IN. \ 5 -10 CM) 2-4 IN 5-10 CM) e FT. (2.4 m) MAXIMUM FIGURE 27 Exception: When the plenum chamber containers filters that do not exceed 10 in. (25.4 cm) in height and the 1 N nozzle can be installed at the intersecting center lines of both filter banks and not exceed the 2-4 in. (5 to 10 cm) distance from either filters, a single 1 N nozzle can be used. See Figure 27a. 2-4 IN. 2-4 IN. 5-10 cm) (5r10 cm) CM) FIGURE 27a NOTICE If 1 N nozzle coverage does not exceed 7 linear ft. (2.1 m), the nozzle can be mounted 2 to 6 in. (5-15 cm) from the face of the filter. For a plenum, either single or "V" bank, with a linear extension longer than 8 feet (2.4 m), each bank may be protected using one 1 N nozzle every 8 ft. (2.4 m) or less depending on the overall length of the plenum. See Figure 28. The nozzles may point in the opposite directions as long as the entire plenum area is pro- tected, and the 8 ft. (2.4 m) limitation is not exceeded. See Figure 29. The nozzle positioning shown in Figure 30 is not an accept- able method of protection because the plenum area directly under the tee is not within the discharge pattern of either nozzle. FIGURE 28 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Plenum Protection (Continued) FIGURE 29 FIGURE 30 Single Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity If the fryer does not have a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 15 in. x 14 in. (38 cm x 36 cm), or a maximum dimension of 15 in. (38 cm) and a maximum area of 210 sq. in. (1355 sq. cm). If the fryer has a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 21 in. x 14 in. (53 cm x 36 cm) or a maximum dimension of 21 in. (53 cm) and a maximum area of 294 sq. in. (1897 sq. cm). The maximum fryer pot size must still not exceed 15 in. x 14 in. (38 cm x 36 cm). The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the hazard area. The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for the pro- tection of fryers. 1. High Proximity Applications: 27 to 47 in. (68 to 119 cm) above the top surface of fryer. See Figure 31a and Figure 31 b. The 230 Nozzle (Part No. 418117) is used for high prox- imity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 230, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the maximum hazard area and angled to the center. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-9 REV. 1 FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM 14 IN. (36 cm) rMAXIMUM I I I 47 IN. (119 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT 230 NOZZLE) 27 IN. (68 cm) MINIMUM HEIGHT 230 NOZZLE) 15 IN. (38 cm) MAXIMUM TOP SURFACE OF FRYER 230 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 31a SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10 REV. 1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Single Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) 1. (Continued) FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD 15 IN. (38 cm) MAXIMUM 14 IN. (38 cm) MAXIMUM (y I I I I II II II I IIIII I 1 1 47 IN. (119 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT 230 NOZZLE) 27 IN. (68 cm) MINIMUM HEIGHT 230 NOZZLE) TOP SURFACE OF FRYER 230 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 31b 2. Low Proximity Applications: 20 to 27 in. (51 to 69 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 32a and Figure 32b. The 245 Nozzle (Part No. 418118) is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 245, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the maximum hazard area and angled to the center. FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM 14 IN. (36 CM) y MAXIMUM I I I I I 27 IN. (69 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT 230 NOZZLE) 20 IN. (51 CM) MINIMUM HEIGHT 245 NOZZLE) TOP SURFACE OF FRYER r-5. cm) MAXIMUM 245 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE. FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD 15 IN. (38 cm) MAXIMUM rc cm) MAXIMUM I I l FIGURE 32a 27 IN. (61 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT 245 NOZZLE) 20 IN. (51 cm) MINIMUM HEIGHT 245 NOZZLE) TOP SURFACE OF FRYER 245 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 32b NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Split Vat Fryer The protection for split vat fryers is the same as the standard fryer coverage as stated on Pages 4-9 through 4-10. Once again, if a fryer does not have a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 15 in. x 14 in. (38 cm x 36 cm), or a maximum dimension of 15 in. (38 cm) and a maximum area of 210 sq. in. (1355 sq. cm),If the fryer has a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 21 in. x 14 in. (53 cm x 36 cm) or a maximum dimension of 21 in. (53 cm) and a maximum area of 294 sq. in. (1897 sq. cm). (The max- imum fry pot size must still not exceed 15 in. x 14 in. (38 cm x 36 cm).) The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the hazard area. See Figure 33. 15 IN. (38 cm) MAXIMUM 14 IN. (36 cm) FIGURE 33 Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow High Proximity/ 12-Flow Low Proximity Fryers exceeding the coverage of a single, 2-flow nozzle (fryer size of a maximum of 14 in. (36 cm) wide by a maximum of 15 in. (38 cm) long for the cooking area or a fryer with a maximum of 14 in. (36 cm) wide x 21 in. (53 cm) long including the drip board) can be protected with multiple nozzles up to a maximum of 6 sq. ft. (.6 m). FRYERS WITH DRIP BOARDS A single R-102 nozzle can protect a maximum surface area of 294 sq. in. (1897 sq. cm) (fry pot area plus drip board area), or a maximum of 210 sq. in. (1355 sq. cm) of cooking area of fry pot only. The longest side of the total hazard must not exceed 21 in. (53 cm). See Figure 33a. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.1 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM 0 15 IN. 294 SO. IN. (1897 sq. cm) ( 38 cm) MAXIMUM 1355 sq. cm) MAXIMUM 14 IN. 36 cm) FIGURE 33a SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.2 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITH DRIP BOARDS (Continued) To properly protect this hazard with multiple nozzles, divide the surface area into modules not exceeding 294 sq. in. (1897 sq. cm) (cooking area plus drip board area) and 210 sq. in. (1355 sq. cm) of fry pot only. When dividing into modules, the longest side of each module must not exceed 21 in. (53 cm). See Figure 33b. THIS IS TOTAL MODULE AREA WITHOUT DRIP BOARD 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION COOKING AREA NOT TO EXCEED 210 SO. IN. (1355 sq. cm) MAXIMUM AREA WITH DRIP BOARD 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION INCLUDING DRIP BOARD COOKING AREA INCLUDING DRIP BOARD NOT TO EXCEED 294 SO. IN. (1897 sq. cm) MAXIMUM FIGURE 33b The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for this protection. 1. High Proximity Applications: 27 to 47 in. (69 to 120 cm) above the top surface of fryer. See Figure 33c. The 230 Nozzle (Part No. 418117) is used for high prox- imity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 230, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. 2. Low Proximity Applications: 20 to 27 in. (51 to 69 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 33c. The 245 Nozzle (Part No. 418118) is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 245, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. To protect each area, the nozzle tip must be located within the perimeter of the area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. See Figure 33c. POSITION NOZZLE TIP ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE PERIMETER OF THE AREA IT IS PROTECTING AND AIM AT MIDPOINT OF THAT MODULAR AREA. J 230 NOZZLE — 27 IN. TO 47 IN. 69 TO 120 cm) ABOVE TOP SURFACE OF FRYER 245 NOZZLE — 20 IN. TO 27 IN. 51 TO 69 cm) ABOVE TOP SURFACE OF FRYER FIGURE 33c See Figure 33d for two examples of modularizing larger drip board fryers. 28 IN. EACH MODULE ( 71 cm) MUST NOT 14 IN. EXCEED (35.6 cm) 294 SO. IN. 1897 sq. cm) I AIM NOZZLE AIM NOZZLE 15 IN. AT MIDPOINT I AT MIDPOINT (38 cm) OF MODULE I OF MODULE 21 IN. c+ y 53 cm) I T I DRIP BOARD I DRIP BOARD EXAMPLE ONLY 30 IN. EACH MODULE (76 cm) MUST NOT 15 IN. EXCEED (38 cm) 294 SO. IN. 1897 sq. cm) I 14 IN. MIDPOINT MIDPOINT (35.6 cm) 19 5/8 IN. 49Icm) 1 DRIP BOARD I DRIP BOARD EXAMPLE ONLY FIGURE 33d NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 2-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITHOUT DRIP BOARDS When protecting a fryer without a drip board using multiple nozzles, the hazard surface area must not exceed 210 sq. in. 1355 sq. cm) per nozzle and the longest side of each module must not exceed 21 in. (53 cm). See Figure 33e. MAXIMUM AREA PER NOZZLE CANNOT EXCEED 210 SO. N. 1355 sq. cm) WITH THE LONGEST SIDE NOT EXCEEDING 21 IN. (53 cm) FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33e To properly protect this hazard, divide the surface area into modules not exceeding 210 sq. in. (1355 sq. cm). When dividing into modules, the longest side of each module must not exceed 21 in. (53 cm). See Figure 33f. MAXIMUM AREA PER NOZZLE CANNOT EXCEED 210 SO. IN. 1355 sq. cm) WITH THE LONGEST SIDE NOT EXCEEDING 21 IN. (53 cm) FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33f R SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.3 The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for this protection. 1. High Proximity Applications: 27 to 47 in. (69 to 130 cm) above the top surface of fryer. See Figure 33g The 230 Nozzle (Part No. 418117) is used for high prox- imity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 230, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the modular area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. 2. Low Proximity Applications: 20 to 27 in. (51 to 69 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 33g. The 245 Nozzle (Part No. 418118) is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 245, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. To protect each area, the nozzle tip must be located within the perimeter of the area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. See Figure 33g. POSITION NOZZLE TIP ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE AREA IT IS PROTECTING AND AIM AT THE MIDPOINT OF THAT MODULAR AREA T-1 i I 230 NOZZLE - i I 27 IN. TO 47 IN. 69 TO 120 cm) I ABOVE TOP i I I OF I I FRYER I I 245 NOZZLE - I 20 IN TO 27 IN. 51 TO 69 cm) ABOVE TOP CE OF I I I FRYER I I I I I I I I MODULE MUST NOT EXCEED 210 SO. IN. (1355 sq. cm) 21 IN. (53 cm) MAXIMUM ON LONGEST SIDE FIGURE 33g SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.4 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Single Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity If the fryer does not have a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 19 1/2 in. x 19 in. (50 x 48 cm), or the fryer can have a maximum area of 370 1/2 sq. in. (2390 sq. cm) with the lon- gest side not to exceed 19 1/2 in. (48 cm). If the fryer has a drip board, the maximum hazard size is 25 3/8 in. x 19 1/2 in. (65 x 50 cm) or the fryer can have a maximum area of 495 sq. in. 3194 sq. cm) with the longest side not to exceed 25 3/8 in. (65 cm). The nozzle must be aimed at the midpoint of the hazard area. The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for the pro- tection of fryers. 1. High Proximity Applications: 21 in. to 34 in. (53 x 86 cm) 34 in. (86 cm) maximum diagonal) above the top surface of fryer. See Figure 33h and Figure 33i. The 3N nozzle, Part No. 76782, is used for high proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 3N, indicating that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the maximum hazard area and aimed at the midpoint. See Figure 33h and 33i. The maximum distance from the midpoint of the fryer to the nozzle tip is 34 in. (86 cm). See Figure 33h and 33i. 3N NOZZLE TIP 34 IN. (86 cm) POSITIONED MAXIMUM DISTANCE TO MIDPOINT ANYWHERE ALONG OR OF HAZARD AREA WITHIN PERIMETERS OF COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT 21 IN. Pk; (53 cm) MINIMUM I I MAXIMUM COOKING AREA, INCLUDING DRIP BOARD. MUST NOT EXCEED 495 SO. IN. (3194 sq. CM) 25 318 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM LONGEST SIDE 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM I I _ r 34 INi ( 86 cm) I MAXIMUM 21 IN. I I DISTANCE TO 53 cm) I I MIDPOINT OF HAZARD MINIMUM I I 1 I 10 3N NOZZLE TIP 34 IN. (86 cm) POSITIONED MAXIMUM ANYWHERE ALONG OR DISTANCE TO WITHIN PERIMETER OF MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE HAZARD AREA AND AIMED AT THE \ MIDPOINT I 21 IN. I 53 cm) I I I MINIMUM I III I I J MAXIMUM COOKING AREA MUST NOT EXCEED 370 112 SO. IN. 2390 sq. cm) 19 1/2 IN. (50 cm) MAXIMUM LONGEST SIDE 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM I I I I I-- — — 1 I I 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM DISTANCE I TO MIDPOINT OF HAZARD 21 IN. 53 cm) MINIMUM I I l I I FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD FIGURE 331 FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD I FIGURE 33h NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Single Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) 2. Low Proximity Applications: 13 to 16 in. (33 to 41 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 33j and 33k. The 290 Nozzle, Part No. 418120, is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned over the midpoint of the hazard area 3 in. from the midpoint along the longest side of the area and +/— 1 in. from the midpoint along the shortest side of the area and aimed at the midpoint. See Figure 33j and 33k. 290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE HAZARD AREA t 3 IN. (7.6 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND f 1 IN. (2.5 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT. MAXIMUM COOKING AREA MUST NOT EXCEED 495 SO. IN. \ 3194 sq. cm) i 25 318 IN. (65 cm) \ 16 IN. MAXIMUM (41 cm) LONGEST SIDE I`\ i i 131N. MAXIMUM i (33 cm) MINIMUM FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33j 290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE HAZARD AREA 3 3 IN. (7.6 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND i 1 IN. (2.5 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT. MAXIMUM COOKING AREA MUST NOT EXCEED 370 1/2 SO. IN. i 16 IN. 2390 sq. cm) \ (41 cm) 19 1/2 IN. \ " MAXIMUM MAXIMUM - I 131N. LONGEST SIDE I I , FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33k SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.5 Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity Fryers exceeding the coverage of a single nozzle (fryer size of a maximum 19 1/2 in. (50 cm) wide by a maximum of 19 in. 48 cm) long for the cooking area or a fryer with a maximum of 19 1/2 in. wide x 25 3/8 in. long (50 x 65 cm) including the drip board) can be protected with multiple nozzles up to a max- imum of 6 sq. ft. (.6 m). FRYERS WITH DRIP BOARDS A single R-102 nozzle can protect a maximum surface area of 495 sq. in. (3194 sq. cm) (fry pot area plus drip board area), or a maximum of 370 1/2 sq. in. (2390 sq. cm) of fry pot only. The longest side of the total hazard must not exceed 25 3/8 in. (65 cm). See Figure 331. TOTAL SURFACE AREA 495 SO. IN. 3194 sq. cm) MAXIMUM 25 3/8 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM nr., __CQT cinc 370 1/2 IN. SO. 2390 sq. cm) MAXIMUM FRY POT AREA ONLY) 19 1/2 IN. (50 Cm) MAXIMUM FIGURE 331 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.6 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITH DRIP BOARDS (Continued) To properly protect this hazard with multiple nozzles, divide the surface area into modules not exceeding 495 sq. in. (3194 sq. cm) (cooking area plus drip board area) and 3701/2 sq. in. (2390 sq. cm) of fry pot only. When dividing into modules, the longest side of each module must not exceed 25 3/8 in. (65 cm). See Figure 33m. THIS IS TOTAL MODULE AREA WITHOUT DRIP BOARD. 25 3/8 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION. (COOKING AREA NOT TO EXCEED 370 1/2 SO. IN. 2390 sq. cm)) THIS IS TOTAL MODULE AREA WITH DRIP BOARD 25 318 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION INCLUDING DRIP BOARD. COOKING AREA INCLUDING DRIP BOARD MUST NOT EXCEED 495 SO. IN. (3194 Sq. cm) FIGURE 33m The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for the pro- tection of fryers. 1. High Proximity Applications: 21 in. to 34 in. (53 to 86 cm) 34 in. (86 cm) maximum diagonal) above the top surface of fryer. See Figure 33n. The 3N nozzle, Part No. 76782, is used for high proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 3N, indicating that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. The maximum distance from the midpoint of the fryer to the nozzle tip is 34 in. (86 cm). See Figure 33n. 3N NOZZLE TIP MUST BE POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF THE MODULAR AREA AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THAT RESPECTIVE AREA. 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM DISTANCE TO MIDPOINT OF HAZARD 21 IN. 53 cm) MINIMUM I I I 34 IN. (86 cm) T_ 1MAXIMUMDISTANCE TO 21 IN. I I MIDPOINT OF 53 cm) I ) HAZARD MINIMUM I I FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33n NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITH DRIP BOARDS (Continued) 2. Low Proximity Applications: 13 to 16 in. (33 to 41 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 33o. The 290 Nozzle, Part No. 418120, is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned over the midpoint of the respective modular area +/— 3 in. from the midpoint along the lon- gest side of the module and +/— 1 in. from the midpoint along the shortest side of the module and aimed at mid- point. See Figure 33o. 290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPONT OF THE RESPECTIVE MODULAR AREA 3 3 IN, FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE MODULE AND t 1 IN. FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE MODULE AND AIMED AT MIDPOINT. 25 3/8 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION MAXIMUM COOKING AREA NOT TO EXCEED 370 1/2 SO. IN. 2390 sq. cm) i I II I 16 IN. 41 CM) MAXIMUM jlyy' j , L 13 IN. 33 Cm) MINIMUM MIDPOINT OF MODULE 25 318 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM DIMENSION MAXIMUM COOKING AREA INCLUDING DRIP BOARD, NOT TO EXCEED 495 SO. IN. 3194 sq. cm) FRYER WITH DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33o SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.7 See Figure 33p for an example of modularizing a larger drip board fryer. EACH MODULAR AREA, INCLUDING DRIP BOARD MUST NOT EXCEED 495 SO. IN. 3194 sq. cm) 34 IN. 86 cm) 17 IN. 43 cm) i MIDPOINT I MIDPOINT 191N. 25 318 IN. I ( 48 cm) 65 cm) I I DRIP BOARD I DRIP BOARD I EXAMPLE ONLY FIGURE 33p 0. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-10.8 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITHOUT DRIP BOARDS When protecting a fryer without a drip board using multiple nozzles, the hazard surface area must not exceed 370 1/2 sq. in. (2390 sq. cm) per nozzle and the longest side of each module must not exceed 25 3/8 in. (65 cm) and aimed at midpoint. See Figure 33q. EXCEED 370 1/2 SO. IN. 2390 sq. cm) WITH THE LONGEST SIDE NOT EXCEEDING 25 318 IN. 65 cm) FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD FIGURE 33q To properly protect this hazard, divide the surface area into modules not exceeding 370 1/2 sq. in. (2390 sq. cm). When dividing into modules, the longest side of each module must not exceed 25 3/8 in. (65 cm). See Figure 33r. CA',CCU Jiu vz au. IN. 2390 sq. cm) 25 3/8 IN. (65 cm) MAXIMUM LONGEST SIDE FIGURE 33r 10 The R-102 system uses two different style nozzles for this protection. 1. High Proximity Application: 21 in. to 34 in. (53 to 86 cm) 34 in. (86 cm) maximum diagonal) above the top surface of the fryer. See Figure 33s. The 3N nozzle, Part No. 76782, is used for high proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 3N, indicating that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the modular area it is protecting and aimed at the mid point of the respective modular area. The maximum distance from the midpoint of the fryer to the nozzle tip is 34 in. (86 cm). 3N NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF THE MODULAR AREA AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THE RESPECTIVE MODULAR AREA. it 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM 0 DISTANCE 2 TO MIDPOINT OF MODULAR AREA I I alllliI 21 IN. 53 cm) MINIMUM i MIDPOINT OF MODULE 34 IN. (86 cm) MAXIMUM 711 i I I I I or - FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD F 34 IN. (8 6 cm) MAXIMUM DIS OINT OF HAZARDTOMIDPOINT I 21 IN. ) 53 cm) MINIMUM FIGURE 33s NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection — 3-Flow High Proximity/ 2-Flow Low Proximity (Continued) FRYERS WITHOUT DRIP BOARDS (Continued) 2. Low Proximity Application: 13 to 16 in. (33 to 41 cm) above top surface of fryer. See Figure 33t. The 290 Nozzle, Part No. 418120, is used for low proximity applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle for fryer protection, the nozzle tip must be positioned over the midpoint of the respective modular area +/— 3 in. from the midpoint along the lon- gest side of the module and +/— 1 in. from the midpoint along the shortest side of the module and aimed at the mid- point. See Figure 33t. 290 NOZZLE TIP MUST BE POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE RESPECTIVE MODULAR AREA 3 31N. (7.6 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE MODULAR AND 3 1 IN. (7.5 cm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE MODULE AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT. i 16 IN. 41 cm) MAXIMUM 13 IN. 33 cm) MINIMUM MIDPOINT OF MODULE FRYER WITHOUT DRIP BOARD Range Protection FIGURE 33t The R-102 system uses three different nozzles for the protec- tion of ranges. 1. High Proximity Application: 40 in. to 50 in. (102 cm to 127 cm) above the cooking surface. The high proximity application uses the 245 nozzle, Part No. 418118. The nozzle tip is stamped with 245 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 245 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 672 sq. in. 4335 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 28 in. x 24 in. 71 cm x 61 cm). When using this nozzle for range protection, the nozzle must be pointed vertically down and positioned as shown in Figures 34 and 35. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-11 REV. 1 28IN. (71 cm) 24 IN. cm) MAXIMUM MAXIMUM Irr i T i< 1 I I I I I I I I I I I 245 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER LINE OF COOKING SURFACE i I I 50 IN. (127 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 245 NOZZLE TIP 140 IN. (102 cm) I I MINIMUMHEIGHT OF 245 I NOZZLE TIP I I I I j O O O O ap FIGURE 34 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-12 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Range Protection (Continued) 1. (Continued) 245 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE OR 11 3/8 IN. (29 cm) MAXIMUM FROM CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE TO CENTER OF ANY. BURNER 245 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE OR 11 3/8 IN. (29 cm) MAXIMUM FROM CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE TO CENTER OF ANY BURNER 28 IN. (71 cm) MAXIMUM 28 IN. (71 cm) MAXIMUM FIGURE 35 NOTICE Four burners shown in Figure 35. For single or double burners, locate nozzle at center of cooking surface or 11 3/8 in. (29 cm) max- imum from nozzle centerline to center of any burner. 2. Medium Proximity Application: 30 in. to 40 in. (76 cm to 102 cm) above the cooking surface. The medium proximity application uses the 260 nozzle, Part No. 418119. The nozzle tip is stamped with 260 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 260 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 672 sq. in. 4335 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 28 in. is 24 in. 71 cm x 61 cm). When using this nozzle for range protection, the nozzle must be pointed vertically down and positioned as shown in Figures 36 and 37. 26 IN. (71 cm) 24 IN. (61 cm) MAXIMUM MAXIMUM I 1 I I I I I ) E TIP LOCATION ULN I LH UNE OF COOKING SURFACE 40 IN. (102 cm) I MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 260 NOZZLE TIP I 30 IN. (76 cm) MINIMUM HEIGHT OF 260 NOZZLE TIP lilrel"o • • FIGURE 36 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Range Protection (Continued) 24 IN. (61 cm) MAXIMUM 260 NOBLE TIP ® 1L—L LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE 28 IN. (71 cm) OR MAXIMUM MAXIMUM FROM CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE TO CENTER OF ANY BURNER 24 IN. (61 cm) MAXIMUM 260 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING 28 IN. (71 cm) SURFACE MAXIMUM OR 11 318 IN. (29 cm) MAXIMUM FROM CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE TO CENTER OF ANY BURNER FIGURE 37 NOTICE Four burners shown in Figure 37. For single or double burners, locate nozzle at center of cooking surface or 11 3/8 in. (29 cm) max- imum from nozzle centerline to center of any burner. 3. Low Proximity Application: 15 in. to 20 in. (38 cm to 51 cm) above the cooking surface. The low proximity application requires two (2) 290 nozzles, Part No. 418120. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290 indicating this is a two flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. Two (2) 290 nozzles will protect a cooking area of 1008 sq. in. (6503 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 28 in. x 36 in. (71 cm x 92 cm). When using two of these nozzles for low proximity range protection, the nozzles must be positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to 1.5 in. (3.8 cm) inside the perimeter, and aimed at a 450 angle along the longitudinal centerline of the range. See Figures 38 and 39. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-13 28 IN. (71 cm) MAXIMUM 36 IN. (91 cm) r MAXIMUM i 290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION 0 — 1.5 IN. 0 — 3.8 cm) IN FROM EDGE OF COOKING SURFACE 45; 45° Ij I I II MINIMUM cm) I I i i MINIMUM cm) II II 20 IN. (51 Cm) 20 IN. (51 cm) MAXIMUM O O O O O O MAXIMUM FIGURE 38 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-14 REV. 1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Range Protection (Continued) 3. (Continued) 36 IN. (91 cm) LONGITUDINAL MAXIMUM CENTERLINE 290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION 0 — 1.5 IN. (3.8 cm) IN FROM EDGE OF COOKING SURFACE 290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION 0 — 1.5 IN. (3.8 cm) IN FROM EDGE OF COOKING SURFACE 28 IN. (71 cm) MAAXIMUM 1 290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE t 2 IN. (5 cm) 36 IN. (91 cm) 28 IN. (71 cm) MAXIMUM -7 MAXIMUM 290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE f 2 IN. (5 cm) FIGURE 39 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Griddle Protection The R-102 system uses four different nozzles for the protection of griddles. One of the applications requires a one -flow nozzle and three of the applications require a two -flow nozzle. One -Flow Griddle Protection 1. High Proximity Application: 35 in. to 40 in. (89 to 102 cm) above the cooking surface. This high proximity application uses the 1 N nozzle, Part No. 56930. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N indicating this is a one - flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. One 1 N nozzle will protect a cooking area of 1080 sq. in. 6968 sq. cm) with the maximum longest side of 36 in. 91 cm). When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to a maximum of 2 in. (5 cm) inside the perimeter, and aimed to the midpoint of the cooking surface. See Figure 40a and 40b. NOTICE When using this type of griddle protection, only 5 flow numbers are allowed on a 1.5 gallon system and only 11 flow numbers are allowed on a 3 gallon system. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-14.1 30 IN. 76 cm) 36 IN. (91 cm) MAXIMUM I r< ) I I II NOZZLE LOCATION 0 - 2 IN. (0 - 5 cm) I INSIDE PERIMETER I I OF COOKING SURFACE ) II/ II I I 40 IN. (102 cm) I I MAXIMUM EDGE OF I I I I HEIGHT OF COOKING I I I 260 NOZZLE TIP SURFACE I 1 / I I 35 IN. (89 cm) MINIMUM I I I I HEIGHT OF260NOZZLE I I I I TIP II I FIGURE 40a MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE I I l I L-------- 1 J IN NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE WITHIN 0 — 2 IN. (0 — 5 cm) OF COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED AT MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE COOKING SURFACE EDGE FIGURE 40b SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-14.2 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Two -Flow Griddle Protection 1. High Proximity Application: 30 in. to 50 in. (76 cm to 127 cm) above the cooking surface. This high proximity application uses the 260 nozzle, Part No. 418119. The nozzle tip is stamped with 260 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 260 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 1440 sq. in. 9290 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 30 in, x 48 in. 76 cm x 122 cm). When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to 2 in. (5.1 cm) inside perimeter, and aimed at the center.of the cooking surface. See Figure 40c and 40d. 30 IN. 30 cm) 36 IN. (91 cm) MAXIMUM r<' I I I I ! I NOZZLE LOCATION 0 — 2 IN. (0 — 5 cm) INSIDE PERIMETER I OF COOKING SURFACE II/ 11 I I I 40 IN. (102 cm) MAXIMUM EDGE OF I I I I HEIGHT OF COOKING I I I I 260 NOZZLE TIP SURFACE 1 I / I I 35 IN. (89 cm) MINIMUM I I I I HEIGHT OFI260NOZZLE II TIP II j FIGURE 40c MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE ' I + I AIM POINT) L-------- 1 J 260 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG ANY SIDE OF COOKING SURFACE EDGE GRIDDLE SURFACE WITHIN 0 — 2 IN. 0 — 5 cm) OF COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED AT MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 46d NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Two -Flow Griddle Protection (Continued) 2. High Proximity Application: 30 in. to 50 in. (76 cm to 127 cm) above the cooking surface. (Continued) This second high proximity application uses the 290 nozzle, Part No. 418120. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 290 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 720 sq. in. 9290 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 24 in. x 30 in. 61 cm x 76 cm). When using this nozzle for high proximity applications, the nozzle must be positioned within 1 in. (2.5 cm) of the center of the cooking surface and pointed vertically down. See Figure 41a and 42b. 30 IN. cm) 24 IN. MAXIM(UMcm) MAXIMUM I I II I I I iI CENTER LINE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE f 1 IN. IN ANY DIRECTION I I I I 50 IN. (127 cm) MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 290 NOZZLE I I TIP 1\ 30 IN. (76 cm) MINIMUM HEIGHT OF 290 NOZZLE TIP FIGURE 41a SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-15 REV. 1 NOZZLE M IN. 161 cm) MAXIMUM LOCATION 1 IN. (2 cm) MAXIMUM CENTER OF GRIDDLE SURFACE OR A MAXIMUM DIMENSION OF 20.6 IN. (52 cm) FROM NOZZLE CENTERLINE TO FURTHEST CORNER OF GRIDDLE 1 IN. (2 cm) MAXIMUM 30 IN. (76 cm) MAXIMUM FIGURE 41b 3. Medium Proximity Application: 20 in. to 30 in. (51 cm to 76 cm) above the cooking surface. The medium proximity application uses the 290 nozzle, Part No. 418120. The nozzle tip is stamped with 290 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 290 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 1440 sq. in. 9290 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 30 in. x 48 in. 76 cm x 122 cm). When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be positioned along the perimeter to 2 in. (5.1 cm) inside perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 42 and 43. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-16 REV. 1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Two -Flow Griddle Protection (Continued) 30 IN. (76 cm) MAXIMUM 46 IN. cm) MAXIMUMUM I< I I I I II j II I I I NOZZLE LOCATION I I 0 - 2 IN. (0 - 5 cm) INSIDE al f.s- PERIMETER OF COOKING SURFACE I I MAXIMUM cm) I I I HEIGHT OF I / I 120 IN. (51 cm) 290 NOZZLE I / I I MINIMUM TIP I HEIGHT OF I I / 290 NOZZLE 1 TIP II I EDGE OF COOKING JI SURFACE FIGURE 42 r r CENTER OF I COOKING SURFACE r AIM POINT) l L--------L J 290 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE WITHIN 0 - 2 IN. (0 - 5 cm) OF COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED AT CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE COOKING SURFACE EDGE FIGURE 43 Low Proximity Application: 10 in. to 20 in. (25 cm to 51 cm) above the cooking surface. The low proximity application uses the 2120 nozzle, Part No. 418121. The nozzle tip is stamped with 2120 indicating this is a two - flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 2120 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 1440 sq. in. 9290 sq. cm) with maximum dimensions of 30 in. x 48 in. 76 cm x 122 cm). When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be positioned along the perimeter to 2 in. (5.1 cm) inside perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 44 and 45. NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Two -Flow Griddle Protection (Continued) 30 , IN MA. XIM(76UM cm) 46 IN. (121 cm) MAXIMUM I I II IIII II NOZZLE LOCATION I 0 — 2 IN. (0 — 5 cm) INSIDE PERIMETER OF COOKING 20 IN. (51 cm) SURFACE I MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF I 2120 NOZZLE TIP l i 10 IN. cm) MINIMUMIIHEIGHTOF I I 2120 NOZZLE TIP I I I EDGE OF COOKING SURFACE FIGURE 44 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-17 REV. 1 rCENTER OF COOKING SURFACE f I I / I AIM POINT) L--------J EDGE OF COOKING SURFACE 2120 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE WITHIN 0 — 2 IN. (0 — 5 cm) OF COOKING SURFACE EDGE NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED AT CENTER OF COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 45 Chain Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses two 1 N Nozzles (Part No. 56930) for chain broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped 1 N, indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number (total of two flow numbers for each chain broiler being protected). Two 1 N nozzles are always needed for chain broiler protection when the hazard area to be protected does not meet the "Over- head Broiler Protection" requirements. The maximum internal size of the broiler is 43 x 31 in. (109 cm x 79 cm). The nozzles must be positioned at each end of the enclosed cooking chamber 1 to 3 in. (2.5 to 7.5 cm) above the surface of the chain and a maximum distance of 4 in. (10 cm) away from the broiler opening. The nozzles may be mounted at either corner as long as they are at opposite ends of the chain broiler and positioned to dis- charge diagonally across the top of the chain. See Figures 46 and 47. 5 cm) FIGURE 46 SECTION IV - SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-18 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Chain Broiler Protection (Continued) MAXIMUM 11 BROILER St 43 X 31 IN. 109 X 79 cn FIGURE 47 Overhead Chain Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses two 1 W Nozzles (Part No. 56927) for overhead chain broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 W, indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. Overhead protection is only available for chain broilers with exhaust opening dimensions that are not less than 60% of the internal broiler length and not less than 60% of the internal broiler width, to a minimum size of 12 in. x 12 in. (30.5 x 30.5 cm). Internal broiler size can not be larger than 32 in. x 34 in. 81 x 86 cm). Example No. 1 - Internal broiler size is 24 in. long x 20 in. wide (61 x 51 cm), with an opening of 16 in. x 16 in. (40.6 x 40.6 cm). To determine minimum opening size, multiply the internal length and the internal width by 0.6: Length of opening - 24 in. x 0.6 = 14.4 in. (61 cm x 0.6 = 36.6 cm) Width of opening - 20 in. x 0.6 = 12.0 in. (51 cm x 0.6 = 30.5 cm) The minimum allowable opening for overhead pro- tection would be 14.4 in. x 12.0 in. (36.6 x 30.5 cm). This example would be acceptable for overhead protection. Example No. 2 - Internal broiler size is 30 in. long x 24 in. wide (76 x 61 cm) with an opening of 22 in. x 12 in. 56 x 30 cm). To determine minimum opening size, multiply internal length and internal width by 0.6: Length of opening - 30 in. x 0.6 = 18.0 in. (76 cm x 0.6 = 45.7 cm) Width of opening - 24 in. x 0.6 = 14.4 in. (61 cm x 0.6 = 36.6 cm) Minimum allowable opening for overhead protection would be 18 in. x 14.4 in. (45.7 x 36.6 cm). Because this broiler has an opening of 22 in, x 12 in., the 12 in. width is below the minimum allowable calculated dimension of 14.4 in. (36.6 cm) and there- fore would not be acceptable for overhead protection. When overhead protection is used, the nozzles must be cen- tered above the exhaust opening within 4 to 8 in. (10 to 20 cm) of each other and they must be located 10 to 26 in. (25 to 66 cm) above the top of the broiler surface. See Figure 48. 4-0 IN. (10.20 cm) 12 IN. (30.5 cm) MINIMUM MAXIMUM INTERNAL BROILER SIZE 32 x 34 IN. 81 x 99 cm) FIGURE 48 The nozzles may vary in position as long as they are evenly spaced from the exhaust center and are always 1800 opposite of each other. If the opening is not square, the nozzles must be positioned along the centerline, parallel to the longest side of the opening. See Figure 49. TOP VIEW 1 T TOP VIEW FIGURE 49 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Nieco Broiler With Catalytic Converter Protection Certain models of the Nieco broiler (Models 940, 962, and 960) are equipped with a catalytic converter to comply with new clean air laws. Because of the converter, it is necessary to protect these broilers in a special way. The guidelines for protecting these broilers are as follows: The maximum internal broiling area is 29 in. x 23.5 in. (74 cm x 60 cm). An R-102 3-gallon system with a maximum of 6 flow numbers, must be used for protection of each broiler, including plenum and duct. Each individual broiler must be protected with a minimum of (2) two, 1 N nozzles, Part No.56930. The nozzles must be located as shown in Figure 50. The broiler must be fitted with two 1 in. (2.5 cm) high agent barriers on the angled surface of the broiler. See Figure 50. If these have not been completed by the equipment sup- plier, they must be added in the field. 30° 0\ 2) 1N NOZZLES PART NO. 56930 ~ D D 1 14.25 f 1 IN. 36 cm) 12 IN. TO 13 IN. 31 cm TO 33 cm) I r tL-- _ J LOCATE NOZZLES 2 13/16 IN. (7.1 cm) ON EACH SIDE OF BROILER CENTER LINE 14.25 3 1 IN. 36 cm) a _ t FIGURE 50 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-19 Upright/Salamander Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses two 1/2N Nozzles (Part No. 56929) for all upright/salamander broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped 1/2N, indicating that this is a half -flow nozzle. A pair of these nozzles will equal one flow number. Two 1/2N broiler nozzles will protect a hazard area (internal broiler chamber) of 30 in. x 32.5 in. (76 cm x 82.5 cm). These nozzles must always be used in pairs on an upright/salamander broiler. One nozzle must be positioned above the grate and pointed at the back opposite corner of the broiler chamber. The second nozzle must be pointed down into the center of the drip pan through the open slot. See Figure 51. SALAMANDER BROILER UPRIGHT BROILER BROILER CHAMBER SIDE VIEW FIGURE 51 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-20 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Electric Char -Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses the 1 N nozzle for the protection of elec- tric char -broilers. The maximum length of the hazard can be no longer than 34 in. (86 cm) and the total hazard area must not exceed 680 sq. in. (4388 sq. cm). 1. Nozzle Location: 20 to 50 in. (51 to 127 cm) above the grate surface. The 1 N Nozzle (Part No. 56930) is used for electric char - broiler applications. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N, indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. When using this nozzle for electric char -broiler protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the maximum hazard area and aim at the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 52. M XI 34 ( 51 cm) I} IN. cm) MAXIMUM I MAXIMUM I i I I I \ I I I 50 IN. (127 cm) I I MAXIMUM I \ / zo7IN(51 cm) MINIMUM FIGURE 52 Gas -Radiant Char -Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses the 245 Nozzle (Part No. 418118) for all gas -radiant char -broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 245, indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. One 245 nozzle will protect a hazard with a maximum length of 24 in. (61 cm) and a total hazard area which does not exceed 528 sq. in. (3406 sq. cm). The nozzle tip must be located 18 to 40 in. (46 to 102 cm) above the hazard surface. When using this nozzle for gas -radiant char -broiler protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the max- imum hazard area and aimed at the center of the cooking sur- face. See Figure 53. i i 1 I 7 1 40 IN.(102 cm) All MAXIMUM I FIGURE 53 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Lava Rock (Ceramic) Char -Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses the 1 N Nozzle (Part No. 56930) for all lava rock char -broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N, indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. One 1 N nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum length of 24 in. (61 cm) and a total hazard area which does not exceed 312 sq. in. (2013 sq. cm). The nozzle tip must be located 18 to 35 in. (46 to 89 cm) above the hazard surface. When using this nozzle for lava rock (ceramic) char -broiler protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the maximum hazard area and angled to the center. See Figure 54. 13 IN. 33 cm) 24 IN. (61 cm) r MAXIMUM I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I / I I I I I I 35 IN. (69 cm) MAXIMUM 111- 7I \ I I FIGURE 54 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-21 Natural Charcoal Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses the 1 N Nozzle (Part No. 56930) for all natural charcoal broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. One 1 N nozzle will protect a hazard area which has a maximum length of 24 in. (61 cm) and a total hazard area which does not exceed 288 sq. in. (1858 sq. cm). The nozzle tip must be located 18 to 40 in. (46 to 102 cm) above the hazard surface. When using this nozzle for natural charcoal broiler protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the max- imum hazard area and aimed at the center of the cooking sur- face. See Figure 55. The coverage of such appliances only applies when the depth of the charcoal does not exceed 4 in. (10 cm). 12 IN. 30 cm) 24 IN. (61 cm) MAXIMUM , I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I 40 IN. (102 cm) I MAXIMUM I I I 16 IN. (46 cm) I \ I MINIMUM I i I 4 IN. (10 cm) MAXIMUM I DEPTH FIGURE 55 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-22 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Alternate Ceramic/Natural Charcoal Char -broiler Protection The R-102 system may also use the 3N nozzle (Part No. 76782) for all ceramic (lava rock) and natural charcoal char -broiler pro- tection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 3N, indicating that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers. One 3N nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum length of 30 in. (76 cm) and a total hazard area which does not exceed 720 sq. in. (4645 sq. cm). The nozzle tip must be located 14 to 40 in. (36 to 102 cm) above the hazard surface. The nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the max- imum hazard area and angled to the center. See Figure 56. For natural charcoal char -boiler protection, this coverage only applies when the depth of the charcoal does not exceed 4 in. 10 cm). 24 IN. (81 ern) 30 IN. (76 cm) r MAXIMUM I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I CS l I I I I I I ao IN. (toe ern) 1 I MAXIMUM I I I I \ 114 IN. (36 cm) 1 \ MINIMUM i 4 IN. (10 cm) MAXIMUM I I DEPTH FIGURE 56 Mesquite Char -Broiler Protection The R-102 system uses the 3N Nozzle (Part No. 76782) for mes- quite char -broiler protection. The nozzle tip is stamped with 3N indicating that this is a three -flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers. One 3N nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum length of 30 in. (76 cm) and a total hazard area which does not exceed 720 sq. In. (4645 sq. cm). The nozzle tip must be located 14 to 40 in. (36 to 102 cm) above the hazard surface. The nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the max- imum hazard area and aimed at the center of the cooking sur- face. See Figure 57. Mesquite logs and pieces, no smaller than 4 in. (10 cm) in length, may be protected with a maximum allowable wood depth of 6 in. (15 cm). 24 IN. 30 IN. (76 cm) 81 cm) MAXIMUM I > i I I I I I I I I I ll I I , I I\ I I I ) 1 I 40 IN. (102 cm) I , l MAXIMUM L_ T 1 I I \ I 114 IN. (38 cm) 1 V// MINIMUM I 8 IN. (15 cm) I I _1L_1LMAXIMUMII DEPTH FIGURE 57 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-23 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Wok Protection The R-102 system uses two different nozzles for the protection of woks. 1. A 260 nozzle, Part No. 418119, will protect a wok 14 in. (36 cm) minimum diameter up to 30 in. (76 cm) maximum diameter. The wok depth must be no less than 3.75 in. (9.5 cm) and no greater than 8 in. (20 cm). The nozzle tip is stamped with 260 indicating that this is a two -flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. When using this nozzle, the nozzle must be positioned as shown in Figure 58. 2. A 1 N nozzle, Part No. 56930, will protect a wok 14 in. 36 cm) minimum diameter up to 18 in. (46 cm) maximum diameter. The wok depth must be no less than 3.75 in. (9.5 cm) and no greater than 5 in. (13 cm). The nozzle tip is stamped with 1 N indicating that this is a one -flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number. When using this nozzle, the nozzle must be positioned as shown in Figure 58. 1 IN. (2 cm) NOZZLE MUST BE POSITIONED RADIUS WITHIN 1 IN. (2 cm) RADIUS - OF THE CENTER OF THE WOK, k_ POINTED VERTICALLY DOWN 1 35 - 45 IN.(89 - 114 Cm) FOR 260 NOZZLE 35 - 40IN. (89 - 102 cm) FOR 1N NOZZLE FIGURE 58 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-24 REV. 1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Nozzle Application Chart The following chart has been developed to assist in calculating the quantity and type of nozzle required to protect each duct, plenum, or appliance. NOTICE This chart is for general reference only. See complete details for each type of hazard. Nozzle Tip Maximum Hazard Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle Stamping — Hazard Dimensions Quantity Heights Part No. Flow No. Duct or Transition Length — Unlimited 1 — 56927/415567 1 W/1 WS Single Nozzle) Perimeter — 27 in. (67 cm) Diameter — 8.5 in. (22 cm) Duct or Transition Length — Unlimited 1 — 56928/78078 2W/2WH' Single Nozzle) Perimeter — 75 in. (190.5 cm) Diameter — 24 in. (61 cm) Duct or Transition Length — Unlimited 2 — 56928/78078' 2W/2WH' Dual Nozzle) Perimeter — 150 in. (381 cm) Diameter — 48 in. (122 cm) Electrostatic Precipitator Individual Cell 1 — 56929 1/2N At Base of Duct) Plenum Length — 8 ft. (2.4 m) 1 — 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Horizontal Protection) Filter Height — 20 in. (51 cm) Plenum Length — 4 ft. (1.2 m) 1 — 56927/415567/417333 1 W/1 WS/1 WSS Vertical Protection) Width — 4 ft. (1.2 m) Fryer/Split Vat Fryer Longest Side without drip board) 15 in. (38 cm) Area — 210 sq. in. 1355 sq. cm) High Proximity 1 27 — 47 in. 418117 230 Low Proximity 1 20 — 27 in. 418118 245 Longest Side (with drip board) 21 in. (53 cm) Area — 294 sq. in. 1897 sq. cm) Fry Pot must not exceed 15in. x14in. 38 cm x 36 cm)) High Proximity 1 27 — 47 in. 418117 230 Low Proximity 1 20 — 27 in. 418118 245 Fryer Longest Side (without drip board) 19 1/2 in. (49.5 cm) Area — 370 1/2 sq. in. 2390 sq. cm) High Proximity 1 21 — 34 in. 76782 3N Low Proximity 1 13 — 16 in. 418120 290 Longest Side (with drip board) 25 1/2 in. (64.5 cm) Area — 495 sq. in. 3194 sq. cm) Fry pot longest side must not exceed 19 1/2 in. and maximum area of 370 1/2 sq. in.) High Proximity 1 21 — 34 in. 76782 3N Low Proximity 1 13 — 16 in. 418120 290 Use 2WH nozzle on t.s gallon, 6 flow, dud and plenum protection only. SECTION IV - SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-25 REV. 1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Nozzle Application Chart Continued) Nozzle Tip Maximum Hazard Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle Stamping - Hazard Dimensions Quantity Heights Part No. Flow No. Range Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 40 - 50 in. 418118 245 28 in. (71 cm) 102 - 127 cm) Area - 672 sq. in. 4335 sq. cm) Longest Side 1 30 - 40 in. 418119 260 Medium Proximity) 76 - 102 cm) 28 in. (71 cm) Area - 672 sq. in. 4335 sq. cm) Longest Side (Low Proximity) 2 15 - 20 in. 418120 290 36 in. (91 cm) 38 - 51 cm) Area - 1008 sq. in. 6503 sq. cm) Griddle Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 30 - 50 in. 418119 260 48 in. (122 cm) 76 - 127 cm) Area - 1440 sq. in. perimeter 9290 sq. cm) located) Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 30 - 50 in. 418120 290 30 in. (76 cm) 76 - 127 cm) Area - 720 sq. in. center located) 1829 sq. cm) Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 35 — 40 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS 36 in. (91 cm) 89 - 102 cm) Area - 1080 sq. in. perimeter 2743 sq. cm) located) Longest Side 1 20 - 30 in. 418120 290 Medium Proximity) 51 - 76 cm) 48 in. (122 cm) perimeter Area - 1440 sq. in. located) 9190 sq. cm) Longest Side (Low Proximity) 1 10 - 20 in. 418121 2120 48 in. (122 cm) 25 - 51 cm) Area - 1440 sq. in. perimeter 9290 sq. cm) located) Chain Broiler' Longest Side - 34 in. (86 cm) 2 10 - 26 in. 56927/415567/417333 1 W/1 WS/1 WSS Overhead Protection) Area - 1088 sq. in. 25 - 66 cm) 7019 sq. cm) Chain Broiler Length - 43 in. (109 cm) 2 1 - 3 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Horizontal Protection) Width - 31 in. (79 cm) 3 - 8 cm) Gas -Radiant Char -Broiler Longest Side - 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 - 40 in. 418118 245 Area - 528 sq. in. 46 - 102 cm) 3406 sq. cm) Electric Char -Broiler Longest Side - 34 in. (86 cm) 1 20 - 50 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area - 680 sq. in. 51 - 127 cm) 4388 sq. cm) Lava -Rock Broiler Longest Side - 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 - 35 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area - 312 sq. in. 46 - 89 cm) 2013 sq. cm) Minimum chain broiler exhaust opening — 12 in. x 12 in. (31 cm x 31 cm). and not less Char 60% of internal broiler size. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-25.1 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Nozzle Application Chart (Continued) Nozzle Tip Maximum Hazard Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle Stamping — Hazard Dimensions Quantity Heights Part No. Flow No. Natural Charcoal Broiler Longest Side — 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 — 40 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area — 288 sq. in. 46 — 102 cm) 1858 sq. cm) Lava -Rock or Natural Longest Side — 30 in. (76 cm) 1 14 — 40 in. 76782 3N Charcoal Char -Broiler Area — 720 sq. in. 36 — 102 cm) 4645 sq. cm) Mesquite Char -Broiler Longest Side — 30 in. (76 cm) 1 14 — 40 in. 76782 3N Area — 720 sq. in. 36 — 102 cm) 4645 sq. cm) Upright Broiler Length — 32.5 in. (82.5 cm) 2 56929 1/2N Width — 30 in. (76 cm) Salamander Length — 32.5 in. (82.5 cm) 2 56929 1/2N Broiler Width — 30 in. (76 cm) Wok 14 in. — 30 in. (36 — 76 cm) 1 35 — 45 in. 418119 260 Diameter 89 — 114 cm) 3.75 — 8.0 in. (9.5 — 20 cm) Deep 14 in. — 18 in. (36 — 46 cm) 1 35 — 40 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Diameter 89 — 102 cm) 3.75 — 5.0 in. (9.5 — 13 cm) Deep SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-25.2 NOTES: SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-26 REV. 1 TANK QUANTITY REQUIREMENTS The purpose of this section is to establish the type of system and quantity of tanks needed to properly supply the discharge nozzles with enough agent at the proper flow rate. Once this is determined, the location of the components will depend on the piping requirements between the tank and the regulated release mechanism, as well as between the tank and each hazard. System Variations 1. The Single -Tank System includes: one agent tank and one regulated release mechanism with an expellant gas car- tridge housed within a single enclosure. 2. The Double -Tank System includes: one agent tank and one regulated release mechanism with an expellant gas car- tridge housed within a single enclosure. Plus, one additional tank with a separate mounting assembly. 3. The Multiple -Tank System varies according to the number of agent tanks required to suit the application. Refer to the chart below for equipment involved: Tank — Remote Regulated Regulated Enclosure/ Mechanical Tank Release Actuator Bracket Release Oty. Assembly Assemblyt Assembly Assemblytt 3 1' 1 1 — — 4 1" 1 2 -- 5 1' 2 2 — — 6 1" 2 3 -- 7 -- 4 3 1 8 -- 4 4 1 9 -- 5 4 1 10 -- 5 5 1 LT-20-R Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 7032). LT-30-R Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 5373). 101.10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15850) or 101-20 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 17492) required. Double -Tank" Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 73022) or 101-30 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15851) required. t"Double-Tank" Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 73022). LT-A-101.30 Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 29187) or 101.30 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15851) required. it101.10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15850) required for actuation only. NOTE: See System Selection Guide in Appendix Section for Cartridge Requirements. ACTUATION GAS LINE WITH AN LT-20-R, LT-30-R. 101.10 OR 101.20 MAX. LENGTH OF 20 FT. (8 m), MAX. NO. OF FITTINGS 9 10 "ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS This section contains the guidelines for installing the actuation and expellant gas lines between the regulated release mecha- nism regulator, each regulated actuator regulator, and each agent tank. These limitations should be considered when selecting the component mounting locations. Actuation Gas Line — 6 Tanks Maximum 1. Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot -dipped galva- nized, chrome -plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings. 2. The actuation gas line piping is installed from the regulated release mechanism to each regulated actuator connected within the system. The total length of the actuation gas line from the regulated release assembly to the regulated actu- ator assembly(ies) must not exceed 20 ft. (6 m) when using an LT-20-R (Part No. 7032), an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge Part No. 5373), or a 101-10 (Part No. 15850) or a 101-20 Part No. 17492) carbon dioxide cartridge. See Figure 59. REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES ///'''''-'' NOT INCLUDED IN ACTUATION/ / GAS LINE LENGTH TOTALS ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY FIGURE 59 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-25 NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Nozzle Application Chart (Continued) Nozzle Tip Maximum Hazard Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle Stamping — Hazard Dimensions Quantity Heights Part No. Flow No. Griddle Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 30 — 50 in. 418119 260 48 in. (122 cm) 76 — 127 cm) Area — 1440 sq. in. perimeter 9290 sq. cm) located) Longest Side (High Proximity) 1 30 — 50 in. 418120 290 30 in. (76 cm) 76 — 127 cm) Area — 720 sq. in. center located) 1829 sq. cm) Longest Side 1 20 — 30 in. 418120 290 Medium Proximity) 51 — 76 cm) 48 in. (122 cm) perimeter Area — 1440 sq. in. located) 9190 sq. cm) Longest Side (Low Proximity) 1 10 — 20 in. 418121 2120 48 in. (122 cm) 25 — 51 cm) Area — 1440 sq. in. perimeter 9290 sq. cm) located) Chain Broiler' Longest Side — 34 in. (86 cm) 2 10 — 26 in. 56927/415567/417333 1 W/1 WS/1 WSS Overhead Protection) Area — 1088 sq. in. 25 — 66 cm) 7019 sq. cm) Chain Broiler Length — 43 in. (109 cm) 2 1 — 3 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Horizontal Protection) Width — 31 in. (79 cm) 3 — 8 cm) Gas -Radiant Ch— !': :: angest Side — 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 — 40 in. 418118 245 Area — 528 sq. in. 46 — 102 cm) 3406 sq. cm) Electric Char -Broiler Longest Side — 34 in. (86 cm) 1 20 — 50 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area — 680 sq. in. 51 — 127 cm) 4388 sq. cm) Lava -Rock Broiler Longest Side — 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 — 35 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area — 312 sq. in. 46 — 89 cm) 2013 sq. cm) Natural Charcoal Broiler Longest Side — 24 in. (61 cm) 1 18 — 40 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Area — 288 sq. in. 46 — 102 cm) 1858 sq. cm) Lava -Rock or Natural Longest Side — 30 in. (76 cm) 1 14 — 40 in. 76782 3N Charcoal Char -Broiler Area — 720 sq. in. 36 — 102 cm) 4645 sq. cm) Mesquite Char -Broiler Longest Side — 30 in. (76 cm) 1 14 — 40 in. 76782 3N Area — 720 sq. in. 36 — 102 cm) 4645 sq. cm) Upright Broiler Length — 32.5 in. (82.5 cm) 2 56929 1/2N Width — 30 in. (76 cm) Salamander Length — 32.5 in. (82.5 cm) 2 56929 1/2N Broiler Width — 30 in. (76 cm) Wok 14 in. — 30 in. (36 — 76 cm) 1 35 — 45 in. 418119 260 Diameter 89 — 114 cm) 3.75 — 8.0 in. (9.5 — 20 cm) Deep 14 in. — 18 in. (36 — 46 cm) 1 35 — 40 in. 56930/415566/417332 1 N/1 NS/1 NSS Diameter 89 — 102 cm) 3.75 — 5.0 in. (9.5 — 13 cm) Deep Minimum chain broiler exhaust opening 12 in. x 12 in. (31 cm x 31 cm). and not less than 60% of internal broiler size. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-26 TANK QUANTITY REQUIREMENTS The purpose of this section is to establish the type of system and quantity of tanks needed to properly supply the discharge nozzles with enough agent at the proper flow rate. Once this is determined, the location of the components will depend on the piping requirements between the tank and the regulated release mechanism, as well as between the tank and each hazard. System Variations 1. The Single -Tank System includes: one agent tank and one regulated release mechanism with an expellant gas car- tridge housed within a single enclosure. 2. 74 The Double -Tank System includes: one agent tank and one regulated release mechanism with an expellant gas car- tridge housed within a single enclosure. Plus, one additional tank with a separate mounting assembly. The Multiple -Tank System varies according to the number of agent tanks required to suit the application. Refer to the chart below for equipment involved: Tank — Remote Regulated Regulated Enclosure/ Mechanical Tank Release Actuator Bracket Release Oty. Assembly Assemblyt Assembly Assemblytt 3 1' 1 1 4 1" 1 2 5 1' 2 2 6 1" 2 3 7 4 3 1 8 4 4 1 9 5 4 1 10 5 5 1 LT-20.R Nitrogen Cartridge (Pan No. 7032). LT-30-R Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 5373). 101.10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15850) or 101.20 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Pan No. 17492) required. Double -Tank" Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 73022) or 101-30 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Pan No. 15851) required. t"Double-Tank' Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 73022), LT-A-101.30 Nitrogen Cartridge (Part No. 29187) or 101.30 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15851) required. tt101.10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge (Part No. 15850) required for actuation only. NOTE: See System Selection Guide in Appendix Section for Cartridge Requirements ACTUATION GAS LINE VATH AN LT-20-R, LT-30-R, 101.10 OR 101.20 MAX. LENGTH OF 20 FT. (8 m), MAX. NO. OF FITTINGS 9 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS This section contains the guidelines for installing the actuation and expellant gas lines between the regulated release mecha- nism regulator, each regulated actuator regulator, and each agent tank. These limitations should be considered when selecting the component mounting locations. Actuation Gas Line — 6 Tanks Maximum 1. Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot -dipped galva- nized, chrome -plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings. 2. The actuation gas line piping is installed from the regulated release mechanism to each regulated actuator connected within the system. The total length of the actuation gas line from the regulated release assembly to the regulated actu- ator assembly(ies) must not exceed 20 ft. (6 m) when using an LT-20-R (Part No. 7032), an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge Part No. 5373), or a 101-10 (Part No. 15850) or a 101-20 Part No. 17492) carbon dioxide cartridge. See Figure 59. REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED IN ACTUATIONGASLINELENGTHTOTALS FIGURE 59 ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS Continued) Actuation Gas Line — 6 Tanks Maximum (Continued) 3. If an expellant gas line is connected to the regulated release assembly along with an actuation gas line, the total com- bined length of the actuation and expellant gas line must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m) when using a "double -tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 73022) or a 101-30 carbon dioxide car- tridge (Part No. 15851). See Figure 60. 4. A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one 901 elbow. SAFETY RELIEF VALVE ACTUATOR AND EXPELLANT GAS LINES WITH A "DOUBLE TANK" CARTRIDGE OR A 101.30 CARTRIDGE MAXIMUM COMBINED LENGTH - 30 FT. (9 m) MAXIMUM COMBINED FITTINGS - 9 EXPELLANT GAS LINE 1 REGULATED ACTUATOR WITH TANK SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-27 REV. 1 Actuation Gas Line — 10 Tanks Maximum 1. Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot -dipped galva- nized, chrome -plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings. 2. The actuation gas line piping is installed from the 101 remote mechanical release to each R-102 regulated actu- ator assembly. The total length of the actuation gas line from the remote mechanical release to the regulated actuator assemblies must not exceed 100 ft. (30.5 m). 3. A combined total of 20 elbows and 9 tees may be used in these lines. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow. See Figure 61. 4. Use only a 101-10 carbon dioxide cartridge (Part No. 15850) in the 101 remote mechanical release. 5. A safety vent relief valve (Part No. 15677) is required in the actuation gas line to relieve residual pressure after actuation. REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY 114 IN. ACTUATION LINE - 100 FT. (30.5 m) MAXIMUM REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY- REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED IN COMBINED TOTALS. AGENT TANK 9 TEES MAXIMUM MAXIMUM OF FIVE REGULATED ACTUATORS FIGURE 60 20 ELBOWS MAXIMUM REMOTE RELEASE MECHANISMS PART NO. 32381) 5 MAXIMUM FIGURE 61 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-28 REV. 1 ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS Continued) Expellant Gas Line 1. The expellant gas line piping is installed from the regulated release mechanism in double and multiple -tank systems, and from the regulated actuator assembly in multiple -tank systems. The expellant gas line is the piping between the regulator and the tank-enclosure/tank-bracket assembly. The total length of the expellant gas line from the regulated release mechanism or each regulated actuator assembly must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m) when using a "double -tank" cartridge (Part No. 73022), an LT-A-101-30 Cartridge (Part No. 29187), or a 101-30 Cartridge (Part No. 15851). See Figures 62 and 63. EXPELLANT GAS LINE MAXIMUM LENGTH - 30 FT. (9 m), MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS - 9 2. A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 45° elbows equal one 900 elbow. 3. If two tanks are connected to the regulated release assembly in a multiple -tank system arrangement, the total combined length of the actuation and expellant gas lines must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m) when using a "double -tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 73022), an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen car- tridge (Part No. 29187) or a 101-30 carbon dioxide cartridge Part No. 15851). See Figure 60. DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS Once the nozzle placement and quantity of tanks has been deter- mined, it is then necessary to determine the piping configura- tions between the tank adaptor and each discharge nozzle. This section contains the guidelines and limitations for designing the distribution piping so that the liquid agent will discharge from the nozzles at a proper flow rate. These limitations should also be referred to when selecting the mounting location for the regu- lated release mechanism and agent tank. General Piping Requirements 1. All R-102 system piping is straight line. Therefore, the need for critical lengths and balancing is minimized. 2 Two 45° elbows count as one 900 elbow. 3. Each branch line includes the tee or elbow leading to it, and all fittings within the branch line itself. 4. The minimum piping length of Schedule 40, 3/8 in. pipe from ANsuL AUTOMAN•• REGULATED RELEASE the tank outlet to any nozzle protecting a range, fryer, or ASSEMBLY wok must be 6 ft. (1.8 m). 5. Pipe lengths are measured from center of fitting to center of fitting. See Figure 64. FIGURE 62 FIGURE 63 CENTER TO CENTER FIGURE 64 6. All distribution piping must be Schedule 40 black iron, chrome -plated, or stainless steel. Do not use hot dipped galvanized pipe on the distribution piping. DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Supply and Branch Line Identification The R-102 distribution piping network is broken down into four specific pipe runs: the Supply Line, the Duct Branch Line, the Plenum Branch Line, and the Appliance Branch Line. See Figure 65. DUCT BRANCH t3LINE SUPPLY LINE r PLENUM APPLIANCE BRANCH LINE BRANCH LINE NOTE: THIS IS A CONCEPTUAL DRAWING ONLY. THIS IS NOT AN ACTUAL INSTALLATION. FIGURE 65 NOTE: THESE ARE EXAMPLES ONLY. OTHER CONFIGURATIONS CAN BE DESIGNED. END OF SUPPLY LINE END OF SUPPLY LINE v END OF SUPPLY LINE BRANCH LINE CANNOT START AHEAD OF A SUPPLY LINE TEE. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 7-1-94 Page 4-29 END OF SUPPLY LINE I END OF SUPPLY LINE 0 ( NOZZLES FOR SUPPLY LINE TEE PLENUM PROTECTION) 1 ^ NOZZLES FOR PLENUM PROTECTION) BRANCH LINE CANNOT START AHEAD OF A SUPPLY LINE TEE. FIGURE 66 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-30 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Supply and Branch Line Identification (Continued) SUPPLY LINE The Supply Line is defined as the length of pipe which runs from the agent tank outlet to the last branch line (whether a duct, ap- pliance, or plenum branch line). This includes all supply line fit- tings except for the tees or elbows leading to the branch lines. See Figures 65 and 66. NOTICE Branch lines cannot start ahead of a supply line tee. DUCT BRANCH LINE The Duct Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe which runs from the supply line to the duct nozzle(s). This includes all branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used to start the branch line. See Figures 65 and 67. DUCT BRANCH LINE ELBOW INCLUDED) V DUCT BRANCH LINE TEE INCLUDED) r 4 v DUCT BRANCH LINES N,, TEES INCLUDED) v i I FIGURE 67 PLENUM BRANCH LINE The Plenum Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe which runs from the supply line to the plenum nozzle(s). This includes all branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used to start the branch line. See Figures 65 and 68. r 4 j PLENUM BRANCH LINE 1 (TEE INCLUDED) I PLENUM BRANCH LINE rEE INCLUDED) FIGURE 68 APPLIANCE BRANCH LINE The Appliance Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe which runs from the supply line to the appliance nozzle(s). This includes 1 all branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used to start j the branch line. See Figures 65 and 69. i I I APPLIANCE BRANCH LINES TEES INCLUDED) FIGURE 69 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REOUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 1.5 Gallon System OPTION 1 — DUCT, PLENUM, AND APPLIANCE PROTECTION 1. Any combination of duct, plenum and/or appliance protec- tion may be used with this option. 2. Only one duct branch line, with one nozzle, either a 1 W or a 2W, may be used with this option. 3. All distribution piping, supply and branch, must be 3/8 in. Schedule 40 black iron, chrome -plated, or stainless steel. 4. Each 1.5 gallon tank allows a maximum of five flow numbers.' 5. The pipe length between the start of the first branch line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed 8 ft. 2.4 m). When the supply line is split, the combined length of both legs of the supply line (start of first branch line to start of last branch line) must not exceed 8 ft. (2.4 m). See Figure 70. 6. The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed 22 ft. (6.7 m). See Figure 71. 7. The requirements of the following table must not be exceeded: SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-31 REV. 1 START OF LAST BRANCH LINE START OF FIRST BRANCH LINE SUPPLY \ LINE TEE START OF FIRST START OF LAST BRANCH LINE BRANCH LINE 1 W NOZZLE TOTAL LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 6 FT. 2.4 m) FIGURE 70 COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT BRANCH LINES IN BOLD) EXCEED 22 FT. (6.7 m) FIGURE 71 Duct Plenum Appliance Requirements Supply Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. Maximum Length 40 ft. 6 ft. 4 ft. 10 ft. 12.2 m) (1.8 m) 1.2 m) 3 m) Maximum Rise 6 ft. 4 ft. 2 ft. 2 ft. 1.8 m) (1.2 m) 6 m) 6 m) Maximum 900 Elbow 9 4 4 6 Maximum Tees 1 1 1 3 Maximum Flow Numbers 5' 2 2 3 Exceptions: 6 flow numbers are allowed when: 1. Duct branch line is the last branch line on the piping net- work, or 11- 2. Only six (6) 1N nozzles". Pan No. 56930. are used, or 3. Only two (2) 3N nozzles. Pan No. 76762. are used. Only five (5) flow numbers are allowed if a 1N nozzle is used for griddle protection. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-32 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 1.5 Gallon System Continued) 114 DIS OPTION 2 — DUCT AND PLENUM PROTECTION ONLY PIP 1. Up to three nozzles, either 1 W or 2WH, may be used with this option for duct protection, however, only two duct nozzles may be used on a single branch line. 2. 1W and 2WH nozzles cannot be mixed on the same duct branch line. 3. Whenever two duct nozzles are used on the same branch line, the flow must enter the bull (side) and exit the ends of the last tee in the branch line to assure balanced flow to each duct nozzle. 4. Appliance branch lines are not allowed with this option. 5. All distribution piping must be only 1/4 In. Schedule 40 black iron, chrome -plated, or stainless steel. Use a 3/8 in. nipple and a 3/8 in. x 1/4 in. reducing fitting for tank adaptor connection to distribution piping. See Figure 72. 6. The pipe length between the start of the first branch line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed 8 ft. 2.4 m). See Figure 73. When the supply line is split, the combined length of both legs of the supply line (start of first branch line to start of last branch line) must not exceed 8 ft. (2.4 m). See Figure 70. 7. The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed 16 ft. (4.9 m). See Figure 73. START OF LAST BRANCH LINE iT NOT 1) 114 IN. DISTRIBUTION 2WH NOZZLES I IN NOZZLES BRANCH LINES IN BOLD) COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 19 FT. (4.9 m) iURE 72 FIGURE 73 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 6.0 Gallon Manifolded System 1. All piping must be 3/8 in. Schedule 40. 2. See Figure 74b for tank connections. 3. The length of supply line piping between the start of the first branch line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed 24 ft. (7.3 m). See Figure 74a. When the supply line is split, the combined total of both legs of the supply line (from the start of the first branch line to the start of the last branch line) must not exceed 24 ft. (7.3 m). 4. The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed 36 ft. (10.9 m). See Figure 74a. 5. A maximum of 22 flow numbers are allowed. 6. The requirements of the following table must not be exceeded. 0. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-34.1 LENGTH OF PIPING MUST NOT EXCEED 24 FT. (7.3 m) FROM START OF FIRST BRANCH LINE TO START OF LAST BRANCH LINE 2WH NOZZLES BRANCH LINES IN BOLD) COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 36 FT. (10.9 m) Duct Plenum Appliance Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. Maximum Length 32 ft. 8 ft. 4 ft. 12 ft. 9.7 m) 2.4 rn) 1.2 m) 3.7 m) Maximum Rise 6 ft. 4 ft. 2 ft. 2 ft. 1.8 m) 1.2 rn) 6 m) 6 m) Maximum 900 8 4 4 6 Elbows Maximum Tees 2 2 1 4 Maximum Flow 22 4 2 4 Numbers FIGURE 74a SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-34.2 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 6.0 Gallon Manifolded System (Continued) This configuration consists of two 3 gallon tanks. Both tanks are connected to a common manifold tee and are pressurized from a single double tank (Part No. 73022) nitrogen cartridge in the regulated release assembly. See Figure 74b. 318 IN. 3/8IN. BRANCH USE HOSE/GROMMET 318 IN. SUPPLY PACKAGE. SUPPLY PART NO. 418511 1 ( 21 5 .5 cmcm) t31UIN. 318 IN. SPPLY BRANCH GALLON I I GALLON TANK3. 0 GALLON RELEASE ASSEMBLY TANK/ ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY DOUBLE TANK NITROGEN CARTRIDGE PART NO. 73022) Independent pipe runs can also be used with the regulated release assembly and the tank/enclosure assembly. See Figure 74c. HOSE/ GROMMET PACKT( PACKAGE PART NO. 41\ 3.0 GALLON 1 3. 0 GALLON TANK TANK OR OR 1.5 GALLON 1.5 GALLON TANK TANK TANKIENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY DOUBLE TANK NITROGEN CATRIDGE PART NO. 73022 OR 101.30 CO2 CARTRIDGE PART NO. 15851 FIGURE 74b I FIGURE 74c 11 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 1.5 Gallon System Continued) 8. Each 1.5 gallon tank allows a maximum of six flow numbers. 9. The requirements of the following table must not be exceeded: Duct Requirements Supply Branch Line Pipe Size 1/4 in. 1/4 in. Maximum Length 40 ft. 6 ft. 12.2 m) 1.8 m) Maximum Rise 12 ft. 4 ft. 3.6 m) 1.2 m) Maximum 900 9 4 Elbows Maximum Tees 1 2 Maximum Flow 6 4* Numbers NOTE: A maximum of two nozzles are allowed per duct branch line. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-33 REV. 1 Plenum Appliance Branch Line Branch Line 1/4 in. 6 ft. Not Allowed 1.8 m) 2 ft. Not Allowed 6 m) 3 Not Allowed 1 Not Allowed 2 Not Allowed SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-34 REV. 1 DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Distribution Piping Requirements — 3.0 Gallon System 1. The maximum length between the start of the first branch line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed 24 ft. (7.3 m). When the supply line is split, the combined total of both legs of the supply line (from the start of the first branch line to the start of the last branch line) must not exceed 24 ft. (7.3 m). See Figure 74. 2. The total length of all branch lines must not exceed 36 ft. 10.9 m). See Figure 74. 3. Use a 3/8 in. union to connect the tank adaptor to the 3/8 in. supply line. 4. A maximum of two nozzles are allowed per duct branch line. 5. The requirements of the following table must not be exceeded: LINE MUST NOT EXCEED 24 FT. (7.3 m) 1N NOZZLE 1/2N NOZZLE BRANCH LINE IN BOLD) COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 36 FT. (10.9 m) FIGURE 74 Duct Plenum Appliance Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. Maximum Length 40 ft. 8 ft. 4 ft. 12 ft. 12.2 m) 2.4 m) 1.2 m) 3.7 m) Maximum Rise 6 ft. 4 ft. 2 ft. 2 ft. 1.8 m) 1.2 m) 6 m) 6 m) Maximum 900 9 4 4 6 Elbows Maximum Tees 1 2 1 4 Maximum Flow 11' 4 2 4 Numbers Elteeptlona: 1. 11.5 flow numbers are allowed when using a Combination of one (1) 2W duct nozzle. one (1) 112N electrostatic precipitator nozzle. one (1) 1N plenum nozzle. and four (4) two -flow appliance nozzles. 2. 12 flow numbers are allowed: a. In any one tank not containing two -flow appliance nozzles", or b. to any one tank using only two -flow appliance nozzles. Only eleven (11) flow numbers are allowed if a 1N nozzle is used for griddle protection. DETECTION SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS Once the fire suppression system design has been determined, a detection system design must be completed. This section con- tains guidelines and limitations for detection system installation. Detector Identification The two types of detectors are distinguished from each other by their location in the detection system. 1. The Terminal Detector (Part No. 56838, 15375, or 417368) is the last in a series of detectors, or the only detector used in a single -detector system. This detector is thus named because it is at the point at which the wire rope ends, or terminates." 2. A Series Detector (Part No. 56837, 15373, or 417369) is any detector located in -line between the regulated release mech- anism and the terminal detector. Detector/Pulley Elbow Quantity The quantity of detectors used in the system will vary depending on the style of detector used. 1. Conduit runs, pulley elbows, and number of detectors per system must be within the approved system guidelines. The following requirements must not be exceeded: Maximum Maximum Maximum Number of Number of Length of 1/2 Detectors Elbows in. Conduit per System per System per System Clip on Style 12 18 125 ft.(38.1 m) Detector Hinge Style 5 8 103 ft.(31.3 m) Detector Scissors Style 15 20 150 ft.(45.7 m) Detector 2. If styles of detectors are mixed within a system, 4 series and 1 terminal is the maximum number allowed. NOTICE When using the "clip -on" style detector, the terminal detector may use the "hinged" style mounting bracket with the "clip -on" style linkage. This is only allowed with the terminal detector. When using this option, the total number of "clip -on" style detectors (11 series and 1 terminal) is still allowed. 3. If detector styles are mixed in the detection system, the max- imum length of wire rope must not exceed 103 ft. (31.4 m) and the maximum number of pulley elbows must not exceed 8. 4. If the hazard requires more than 15 detectors, up to five 101 Remote Releases (Part No. 12029) can be used for system actuation. Each 101 remote release allows the use of a maximum of 15 "scissor" style detectors (14 series and 1 terminal) for a total of 75 detectors if needed. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-35 Detector Placement Requirements EXHAUST DUCTS Each exhaust duct must have at least one detector installed in the duct entrance, located in the airstream of the cooking vapors, or at a maximum of 20 ft. (6.1 m) into the duct opening. See Figure 75. FIGURE 75 NOTICE When gas appliances are used and the flue gases from the burner are exhausted into the duct, the detector must be kept out of the air stream of these exhaust gases. These gases can be very hot and could actuate the system unnecessarily. Duct openings that are long and narrow or large enough to require multiple duct nozzles may require additional detectors. ELECTROSTATIC PRECIPITATOR If an electrostatic precipitator is located at or near the base of the exhaust duct, it is necessary to locate a detector below the precipitator, at the base of the duct, and also locate one in the duct, just above the precipitator. See Figure 76. When installing the detector bracket and system conduit, make certain they do not interfere with the operation of the precipitator. 1< FIGURE 76 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-36 DETECTOR SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Detector Replacement Requirements (Continued) COOKING APPLIANCES If the cooking appliance is located under an exhaust duct where a detector has been mounted, it is normally not necessary to utilize another detector for that cooking appliance, provided the detector is not more than 12 in. (30 cm) into the duct. See Figure 77. APPLIANCE REOUIRES SEPARATE DETECTOR APPLIANCE COVERED BY DETECTOR UNDER DUCT APPLIANCE COVERED BY DETECTOR UNDER DUCT APPLIANCE REQUIRES SEPARATE DETECTOR FIGURE 77 Detectors used for cooking appliances must be located above the surface and within the perimeter of the cooking appliance. They must be positioned toward the exhaust duct side of the appliance and high enough to prevent accidental actuation of the system. The cooking appliance detectors must be located in the air stream of the cooking fumes for quick fire detection. It is normally necessary to use one detector per area of single nozzle coverage, even though more than one appliance may be covered with a single nozzle. Detection Line Requirements CONDUIT Rigid conduit, 1/2 inch Schedule 40 galvanized pipe, or 1/2 inch EMT thin -wall conduit may be used. Standard steel conduit fit- tings (compression type are recommended) must be employed to properly install the detection system. All conduit or pipe must be firmly supported. When using pipe, make certain that all ends are carefully reamed, deburred and blown clear of chips and scale before assembly. NOTICE The conduit offset can be used at the top or bottom of the regulated release to change direction of the conduit. The conduit offset cannot be used with pulley tees. All other changes in direction must be made by using Ansul approved pulley elbows, Part No. 45771 or 415670. See Figure 78. FIGURE 78 Fusible Link Selection When possible, temperature readings should be taken at each detector location to determine correct fusible link temperature rating. Temperature can be recorded using either a maximum registering thermometer, Part No. 15240, temperature tape or any other accurate thermometer. O O AN,1 TEMPERATURE RATING STAMPED ON FUSIBLE LINK BODY K STYLE ML STYLE SOD °F (2W "C) ONLY FIGURE 79 Select correct UL Listed fusible link(s) for installation in detector(s) according to the temperature condition chart below: Temperature To Be Used Where Fusible Link Rating Temperature Does Part No. See Figure 79) Not Exceed 415739 165 OF 74 °C) 100 OF (38 °C) 415740 212 OF 100 °C) 150 OF (66 °C) 415741 280 OF 138 °C) 225 OF (107 °C) 415742 360 OF 182 °C) 290 OF (143 °C) 415743 450 OF 232 °C) 3e0 OF (182 °C) 56816 500 OF 260 °C) 400 OF (204 °C) MANUAL PULL STATION REQUIREMENTS A remote manual pull station allows the R-102 system to be manually operated at some point distant from the regulated release assembly. The pull station should be installed at a max- imum height of 60 in. (152 cm) and located in the path of exit. The pull station is the only source of manual actuation of the regulated release assembly. Two styles of remote pull stations are available: metal stamped and plastic molded. P. The total length of the cable used for each manual pull station within a system must not exceed 150 ft. (46 m). The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used per system is 20. One pulley tee, Part No. 15342, is allowed per system. Exception: When using a pulley tee, Part No. 15342, in the pull station line, the maximum length of wire rope to each pull sta- tion must not exceed 125 ft. (38 m) and the maximum number of elbows must not exceed 18. Metal Stamped Style — Part No. 4835 or 54011 Parts that may be used for installation of a metal stamped remote manual pull station are: Description Part No Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly' 54011 Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly 4835 Pulley Elbow 45771 Pulley Elbow 415670 Pulley Tee' ' 15342 Assembly includes parts listed below: 1/16" Stainless Steel Cable 50 ft. (15 m) 15821 Oval Press -To -Crimp Sleeves 4596 Glass Break Rod (1) 4834 Designed for 32 IF to 130 IF (0 °C to 54 °C) temperature areas. Utilized when two remote manual pull stations are being connected to one regulated release assembly. Plastic Molded Style — Part No. 415255 Parts that may be used for installation of a plastic molded remote manual pull station are: Description Part No. Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly 415255 Trim Ring Shipping Assembly (25) 415256 Replacement Seal Shipping Assembly (25) 415317 1/16" Stainless Steel Cable 500 ft. (152 cm) 79653 Oval Press -To -Crimp Sleeves 4596 Pulley Elbow 45771 Pulley Tee 15342 MECHANICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS An Ansul or Ansul approved mechanical gas shut-off valve system can be attached to the R-102 system. The system works both mechanically and pneumatically by use of an air cylinder located inside the regulated release assembly. Upon actuation of the fire suppression system, a pneumatically -operated air cyl- inder assembly will mechanically close the gas shut-off valve. The total length of the cable for the mechanical gas valve must not exceed 150 ft. (46 m). The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used is 20. One pulley tee (Part No. 15342) is allowed per system. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-37 REV. 1 P. Exception: When using a pulley tee, Part No. 15342, the max- imum length of wire rope to each gas valve must not exceed 125 ft. (38 m) and the maximum number of elbows must not exceed 18. Parts that may be used for installation of a Mechanical Gas Shut- off Valve are: Description Part No. Gas Valve/Actuator 3/4 in. Assembly (Ansul)' 55598 Gas Valve/Actuator 1 in. Assembly (Ansul)' 55601 Gas Valve/Actuator 1 1/4 in. Assembly (Ansul)' 55604 Gas Valve/Actuator 1 112 in. Assembly (Ansul)' 55607 Gas Valve/Actuator 2 in. Assembly (Ansul)' 55610 Gas Valve/Actuator 2 1/2 in. Assembly (ASCO)' 25937 Gas Valve/Actuator 3 in. Assembly (ASCO)' 25938 Pulley Elbow" 45771 Pulley Elbow" 415670 Pulley Tee' ' ' 15342 1/16" Stainless Steel Cable 15821 or 50 ft. (15 m) or 500 ft. (152 m) roll 79653 Oval Press -To -Crimp Sleeve 4596 Stop Sleeve (2) 26317 Assemblies include pans listed below: Approved for 700 IF (371 °C) temperature areas. Used with two (2) ANSUL AUTOMAN releases to operate one (1) mechanical gas valve. Air Cylinder Assembly 15733 Air Cylinder 15521 Tubing Assembly 15529 Copper Tubing, 1/8 in. 15525 Male Elbow 15523 Male Connector 15522 Machine Screw (2) 15421 Hex Nut (2) 15527 Lockwasher (2) 4141 Visual Inspection Seal (2) 197 All valves above are UL listed and approved. They may be mounted in any position. Pipe threads are type NPT. Ambient operating temperature range of all valves is 32 IF to 120 IF 0 °C to 49 °C). The valves are not weatherproof and must be located indoors in areas approved by the "authority having jurisdiction." ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS A UL Listed electrically -operated gas shut-off valve can be attached to the R-102 system to provide an electrical means of shutting off the gas line at a predetermined point. If an electric gas shut-off valve is used in the system it must be attached with both an electric (snap -action) switch and a manual reset relay. For more information on the types of electric (snap -action) switches, refer to the Electrical Switch, Field Installation sec- tion on Page 5-24. The manual reset relay is reviewed in this section. All electrical connections should be performed by a QUALIFIED ELECTRICIAN and in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. The following is a brief explanation of how the R-102 system operates with an Electric Gas Shut-off Valve attached: With the regulated release cocked in the ready condition, the normally closed contacts in the snap -action switch allow current to flow to the manual reset relay. With the relay coil energized, normally open contacts in the reset relay close, allowing the sole- noid in the gas valve to be energized. SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 4-38 REV. 1 ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Once the R-102 system is activated, the normally closed con- tacts in the snap -action switch will open, de -energizing the reset relay. This will, in turn, open the contacts in the relay which will cause the gas valve to become de -energized and close. The system must be re -armed and the "push to reset" button on the reset relay must be operated to reopen the gas valve. It is important to note that a power failure or an electrical power interruption will cause the gas valve to close even though the system was not fired. In either case, whether in a fired condition or when a power failure has occurred, the manual reset relay and electric gas shut- off valve must be reset to resume a normal operating condition. For resetting, refer to the "Recharge and Resetting Proce- dures" section In this manual. Approvals Ansul gas valves listed in this section are UL listed and approved for 110 VAC. If more information is required, refer to the Gas and Oil Equipment List of Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. under Electrically Operated Valves Guide No. 440 A5" or consult Ansul Fire Protection, Marinette, Wisconsin 54143-2542. If other gas valves are used, they shall be "UL listed electrically - operated safety valves for natural or LP gas as required, of appropriate pressure and temperature rating, 110 VAC/60 Hz." The information on temperature and type of gas that the valves are suitable for may be found in the Gas and Oil Equipment List of Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. under "Electrically Operated Valves Guide No. 440 A5." The electrically operated gas valve must be of the type that needs to be energized to remain open. Parts that may be used for installation of a 110 VAC Gas Shut- off Valve are: Description Part No. Electric Solenoid Valve, 3/4 in. NPT' 13707 Electric Solenoid Valve, 1 in. NPT' 13708 Electric Solenoid Valve, 1 1/2 in. NPT' 13709 Electric Solenoid Valve, 2 in. NPT' 13710 Electric Solenoid Valve, 3 in. NPT' 17643 Manual Reset Relay (110 VAC) 14702 Valves ere normally closed when de -energized. PRESSURE SWITCH REQUIREMENTS The pressure switches for the R-102 system are specially designed. The switches are intended for use with electric gas valves, alarms, contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric power shut-off devices, and other electrical devices that are designed to shut off or turn on when the fire suppression system is actuated. Pressure Switches that may be used on system are: Description Part No. Single -Pole, Double -Throw' Double -Pole, Double -Throw' 53133 24377 Rated for 20 amps, 125, 250 or 480 VAC with 10 amp 125 VAC " L" 1 hp•1 t 5 VAC. 2 hp•230 VAC. 1/2 amp 125 VDC. 114 amp 250 VDC. A relay must be supplied by others if equipment load exceeds the rated capacity of the switch. ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS The electric (snap -action) switches for the R-102 system are spe- cially designed to fit the regulated release assembly. The switches are intended for use with electric gas valves, alarms, contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric power shut-off devices, and other electrical devices that are designed to shut off or turn on when the fire suppression system is actuated. (See Figures 84 through 86 for reference.) Contractors shall supply "UL listed, enclosed industrial control equipment or magnetic switch having a rating matching that of the cooking appliance, coil 110 VAC/60 Hz or 24 VAC/60 Hz." All electrical connections should be performed by a QUALIFIED ELECTRICIAN and in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. Electric (Snap -Action) Switches that may be used are: Description Part No. Single -Pole, Double -Throw Assembly' 15549 Assembly Includes: Snap -Action Switch 17781 Wire Assembly Connector 17765 Self -Tapping Screws (2) 15609 Lock Nut 21918 Screw 415870 Double -Pole, Double -Throw Assembly' 32222 Assembly Includes: Snap -Action Switch (2) 17781 Wire Assembly Connector (2) 17765 Self -Tapping Screws (2) 32085 Trip Lever Pin 415844 Lock Nut 21918 Three -Pole, Double -Throw Assembly' 415868 Assembly Includes: Snap -Action Switch (3) 17781 Wire Assembly Connector (3) 17765 Machine Screw w/Hex Nut (2) 32221 Trip Lever Pin 415844 Lock Nut 21918 Four -Pole, Double -Throw Assembly' 32220 Assembly Includes: Snap -Action Switch (4) 17781 Wire Assembly Connector (3) 17765 Machine Screw w/Hex Nut (2) 32221 Trip Lever Pin 415844 Lock Nut 21918 Rated for 15 amps. 113 hp, 125 or 250 VAC, with 1/2 amp 125 VDC and 114 amp 250 VDC. A relay must be supplied by others, if equipment load exceeds the rated capacity of the switch. Electrical wiring and equipment shall be installed in accordance with NFPA 70 (National Electrical Code) or the requirements of the authority having jurisdiction. If a fire alarm system is provided, the fire extinguishing system shall be connected to the alarm system in accordance with the requirements of the appropriate Signalling Standard (NFPA 71, 72A, 72B, 72C or 72D) so that the actuation of the extinguishing system will sound the fire alarm as well as provide the extin- guishing function of the system. If supervision of the electrical detection, electrical actuation or electrical power supply circuit is provided, it shall give prompt audible or visual indication of trouble and shall be distinctive from alarms or indicators indicating operation or hazardous con- ditions as specified in NFPA 17A. ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Electric (110 VAC/60 Hz) Gas Shut-off Valve INSTALLATION OVERVIEW POWER SOURCE -*" ELECTRIC SNAP -ACTION SWITCH BASIC WIRING DIAGRAM POWER SOURCE SNAP -ACTION SWITCH A JUNCTION BOXES NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) MANUAL RESET RELAY NOTE: DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP -ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS. ETA. WIRING SCHEMATIC L1 BLACK 110V/60HZ T RED L2 BROWN SNAP -ACTION SWITCH PART NO. 15549 MANUAL RESET RELAY PART NO. 14702 n J--1- K. N.O. K1aT y i PUSH BUTTONN.O. K SWITCHs 7 ------"J I SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-39 MANUAL RESET RELAY ELECTRIC GAS VALVE S VALVE K1e and K1b are N.O. when K1 is de -energized. NOTE: 1. DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION. 2. _ _ _ _ _ DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION. 3. GAS VALVES: "UL LISTED ELECTRICALLY -OPERATED SAFETY VALVE FOR NATUAL. OR LP GAS AS NEEDED OF APPROPRIRATE PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE RATING, 110V/60 HZ" OR ANSUL GAS VALVES, PART NUMBERS 13707, 13708. 13709. 13710, AND 17643. GAS VALVE SEE NOTE 3 FIGURE 80 SECTION IV — SYSTEM DESIGN U L EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-40 ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Electric (110 VAC/SO Hz) Application with Customer Supplied Contactor and Heating Element Load INSTALLATION OVERVIEW BASIC WIRING DIAGRAM POWER SOURCE FL1L2 /- POWER SOURCE I 0 L/ RELAY MANUAL RESET ELECTRIC SNAP -ACTION SWITCH JUNCTION BOX NOT SUPPLIED BY.ANSUL) \ \ POWER O"FF SWITCH i (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) BLACK (HOT) WHITE (NEUTRAL) RED (COMMON) U BROWN (N.C.) O m ? I T SNAP -ACTION SWITCH MANUAL RESET RELAY NOTE: DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP -ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS, ETC. WIRING SCHEMATIC L1 BLACK_ 110V/60HZ RED L 2 BROWN SNAP -ACTION SWITCH - PART NO. 16649 CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) POWER ON -OFF SWITCH (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) 1 MANUAL RESET RELAY PART NO. 14702 K 1. I1 eN.O. TKPUSH K1bN.O.' iSWITCHUTTON illl I aF__ J TO POWER SUPPLY 220V/440V TO HEATING ELEMENT LOAD K1a and K1b are N.O. when Kt Is dedner&9d. CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) SEE NOTE 3 r --- - I I POWER ON -OFF I i ' SWITCH (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) I I I I I TO POWER SUPPLY e- t.— 220V/440V TO HEATING - ELEMENTLOAD NOTE: I. DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION. 2. _ _ _ _ _ DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION. 3. CONTRACTORS: " UL LISTED ENCLOSED INDUSTRIAL CONTROL EOUIPMENT OR MAGNETIC SWITCH HAVING A RATING MATCHING THAT OF THE COOKING APPLIANCE COIL, 110V/60HZ." FIGURE 81 SECTION IV - SYSTEM DESIGN UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 4-41 ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS (Continued) Electric (110 VAC/60 Hz) Application with Customer Supplied Contactor and Heating Element Load, and Power Supply Switch INSTALLATION OVERVIEW POWER SOURCE ELECTRIC SNAP -ACTION SWITCH JUNCTION BOX NOT SUPPLIED BY AIISUL) BASIC WIRING DIAGRAM POWER SOURCE MANUAL RESET RELAY L7 BLACK (HOT) 1 L2 WHITE (NEUTRAL) , 2 RED (COMMON) 3) 1 BROWN (N.C.) n g dmz VAP-ACTION SWITCH NOTE: DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP -ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS. ETC. WIRING SCHEMATIC L1 BLACK 110V/60HZ I— SNAP -ACTION SWITCH RED L2 PART NO. 15549 I BROWN SWITCH OR THERMOSTAT CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) L1 110V/60HZ _ L2 — MANUAL RESET 01 RELAY O SWITCH OR THERMOSTAT CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) SWITCH OR THERMOSTAT CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) TO POWER 7 SUPPLY 220V/440V I TO HEATING Jr ELEMENT LOAD K1a and K1b are N.O. when K1 Is de -energized. 1 MANUAL RESET RELAY PART NO. 14702 Z`J- 3 y- I K1. I 1 NA. KeeT 4i PUSH BUTTON K1bs N.O. i SWITCH I R CONTACTOR CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) 1 SEE NOTE 3 1 1 I Lill TO POWER SUPPLY 220V1440V TO HEATING ELEMENT LOAD NOTE: 1. DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION. 2. _ _ _ _ _ DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION. 3. CONTRACTORS: "UL LISTED ENCLOSED INDUSTRIAL CONTROL EQUIPMENT OR MAGNETIC SWITCH HAVING A RATING MATCHING THAT OF THE COOKING APPLIANCE COIL, 110V/60HZ." FIGURE 82 INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS Before attempting any installation, the entire system design must have been determined including: Nozzle Placement, Tank Quan- tity, Actuation and Expellant Gas Piping, Distribution Piping, and Detection System Requirements and an installation sketch should be completed. MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS For successful system performance, the regulated release assembly, regulated actuator assembly(ies), and tank- enclosure(s) or tank -bracket assembly(ies) used must be located in areas where the air temperature will not fall below 32 OF 0 °C) or exceed 130 OF (54 °C). Also, the components must be arranged to conform to the actuation and expellant gas line, and the distribution piping guidelines noted in "System Design." Use only an ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release assembly (Part No. 79290 — 3.0 gallon mechanical or 79292 — 3.0 gallon electrical or 79291 — 1.5 gallon mechanical or 79493 — OEM Release/Bracket Assembly). The regulator in this assembly is specifically designed to allow a regulated flow of expellant gas into the agent tank(s). Absence of this regulator could cause the tank(s) to rupture or create an improper system discharge. Mount the regulated release assembly, OEM Release Assembly, and each regulated actuator assembly required by completing the following steps: See Figures 1, 2, and 3. a. Select a rigid surface for mounting the enclosure. The mounting locations must allow the regulated release assembly and the regulated actuator assembly(ies) to be within the limitation of the actuation and expellant gas line lengths and must be able to support the weight of the assembly(ies). b. Detach cover from the enclosure. Remove agent tank from enclosure and the expellant gas line hose from the tank/adaptor assembly. c. Secure enclosure box to selected mounting location using the four mounting holes. Use appropriate type of fasteners depending on the mounting surface. d. When mounting a 6-gallon manifolded system (or a 6- gallon individual piped system) it is critical that each mounting box is located as shown in Figure 3a. There must be a 5/16 in. space between each box. Less than 5/16 in. will cause interference with the covers, and more than a 5/16 in. will cause a gap between the two hose grommets which will expose the hose to possible tampering or damage. Remove the 7/8 in. knockout in the left side of the ANSUL AUTOMAN release box and remove the 1 in. knockout in the right side of the tank -enclosure box. Install grommets in each (use Ansul hose/grommet package, Part No. 418511). Remove 1/4 in. plug from back side of R-102 regular and install fixed end of secondary expellant gas hose (included in hose/grommet package, Part No. 418511) in 1/4 in. regulator outlet and wrench tighten. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-1 REV. 1 If not already done, mount both boxes to a rigid sur- face using appropriate fasteners. Fill tanks per instructions listed in Steps 3 and 4 on Page 5-3. Next, route hose through grommets and wrench tighten into 1/4 in. inlet of the adaptor on the tank in the tank/enclosure assembly. Also install hose to tank adaptor in regulated release and wrench tighten. See Figure 74b for details of hose routing. REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY 16 1/2 IN. 42 cm) 13 13116 22 112 IN. 57 cm) 19 1/16 IN. 48.4 cm) j —>' 7 1/2 IN. 19 cm) FIGURE REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY 16 1/2 IN. 412 cm) 13 13116 IN. 35 cm) 0 22 1/2 IN. i I (57 cm) 0 19 1/16 IN. 7 1/2 IN. FIGURE 2 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-2 REV. 1 MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS (Continued) OEM RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY 7.0 6.0 18 cm)r(15 cm) 1.0 r pC c 38 Q r Q 18.5 47 cm) 15.0 38 cm) 62 62 MULTIPLE TANK ASSEMBLY 6 5116 IN. 3 118 IN. 06 cm) (8 cm) 13 13/16 IN. LOCATION OF P25 cm) GROMMETS 19 7116 IN. I 1 49 cm) I FIGURE 3 19 7/16 IN. I (49 cm) 5/16 IN. .28 IN. (.7 cm) 8 cm) HOLE (7YP) FIGURE 3a CAUTION Do not install cartridge at this time or system may be actuated. 2. Mount each tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly by completing the following steps: a. Select a rigid, vertical surface for mounting the enclosure or bracket. (Keep in mind that the 3 gallon tank is taller than the bracket. Allow sufficient space for convenient piping and removal.) b. Remove tank from enclosure or bracket, and secure enclosure or bracket to the mounting location using the four mounting holes. Use appropriate type of fasteners depending on the mounting surface. 3 112 IN. 9 cm) 9 314 IN. 25 cm) 8 5/8 IN. 22 cm) 7 13116 IN. 20 cm) 9 IN. cm) r(22.9 Imo_ r+6 5116 IN. i (16 cm) I I 1/2 IN. 57 .2 cm) 19 7/16 IN. 49.4 cm)) 71121N. 19.1 cm) FIGURE 4 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-2.1 MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS (Continued) 3. Fill each agent tank by completing the following steps: a. Remove tank adaptor/tube assembly from tank fill opening. Visually inspect tank adaptor to determine bursting disc is in place and that silver side is away from tank. See Figure 5. a FIGURE 5 Safety glasses should be worn during transfer oper- ations of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppres- sant. Avoid contact with skin or eyes. In case of contact, flush immediately with water for 15 minutes. If irritation persists, contact a physician. Do not take internally. If taken internally do not induce vomiting. Dilute with water or milk and contact a physician immediately. Place plastic funnel in fill opening and fill tank with 1.5 gallons (5.8 L) or 3 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. When the tank con- tains a complete charge, the liquid level should be 1 in. t 1/8 (2.54 cm f .3 cm) from the bottom of the fill opening. See Figure 6. Make certain tank is filled to 1 in. t 1/8 in. (2.54 cm f .3 cm). DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in agent entering gas hoses and regulator potentially causing system malfunction. 1 in. ; 1/8 2.54 cm i .3 cm) FIGURE 6 c. Reinstall adaptor/tube assembly to tank by tightening until metal to metal contact is achieved between bottom of adaptor and tank collar. 4. Place each tank into its enclosure or bracket. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-3 INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE Before installing any actuation or expellant gas line, the piping design must be determined; and the regulated release assembly, each regulated actuator assembly and each tank -bracket assembly should be'securely mounted. General Piping Requirements 1. Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron,, hot -dipped galva- nized, chrome -plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings. 2. Before assembling the pipe and fittings, make certain all ends are carefully reamed and blown clear of chips and scale. Inside of pipe and fittings must be free of oil and dirt. 3. The piping and fitting connections must be sealed with pipe tape. When applying pipe tape, start at the second male thread and wrap the tape (two turns maximum) clockwise around the threads, away from the pipe opening. NOTICE Do not allow tape to overlap the pipe.opening, as this could cause possible blockage of the gas pressure. Thread sealant or compound must not be used. 4. When connecting actuation or expellant gas line piping, install a 1/4 in. union near the tank inlet for easy disassembly later. Actuation Gas Line Install actuation gas line from the regulated release mechanism high pressure side outlet (side opposite regulated outlet) through the appropriate knockout in the enclosure by completing the fol- lowing steps: 1. Remove the 1/8 in. plug from high pressure side outlet. Install the appropriate fitting for additional equipment attach- ment as required. A 1/4 x 1/8 in. reducing fitting is required to connect the 1/4 in. actuation line. See Figure 7. Typical Arrangements For A One Device Connection To Cartridge Receiver Typical Arrangements For A Two Device Connection To Cartridge Receiver e s s I Typical Arrangements For A Three Device Connection To Cartridge Receiver TO TANK IN VT109 IN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY TO REGULATED ACTUATOR MULTIPLE TANKS ONLY) TO TANK IN BRACKET OR ENCLOSURE 2 IN. NIPPLE REOUIRED TO TANK IN ntLwLA i to RELEASE REOULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY TO REGULATED ACTUATOR MULTIPLE TANKS ONLY) TO TANK IN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY SINGLE TANK DOUBLE AND SINGLE TANK DOUBLE AND MULTIPLE MULTIPLE TANKS WITH PRESSURE TANKS WITH SWITCH CONNECTION PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTION NOTE: ALL PIPE AND FITTINGS SHALL BE SCHEDULE 40 (STANDARD WEIGHT) BLACK IRON, HOT -TIPPED GALVA• FIGURE 7 NIZED, CHROME -PLATED, OR STAINLESS STEEL. 10 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-4 REV. 1 INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE Continued) Actuation Gas Line (Continued) 2. Run piping up through the regulated release assembly enclosure knockout to the inlet on top of each regulated actuator assembly used within the system. 3. The total combined length of the actuation gas line from the regulated release assembly to all regulated actuator assemblies must not exceed 20 ft. (6 m) when using an LT-20-R nitrogen cartridge (Part No.7032), an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 5373), a 101-10 CO2 cartridge Part No. 15851), or a 101-20 CO2 cartridge (Part No. 17492). See Figure 8. ACTUATION GAS LINE WITH AN LT-20-R, LT-30-R, 101.20 OR 101.30 CARTRIDGE. MAXIMUM LENGTH - 20 FT. (6 m), MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS - 9 REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINES WITH A "DOUBLE -TANK" OR 101.30 CARTRIDGE MAXIMUM COMBINED LENGTH - 30 FT. (9 m), MAXIMUM COMBINED FITTINGS - 9 4. If an expellant gas line is connected to the regulated release assembly along with an actuation gas line, the total com- bined length of the actuation and expellant gas line must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m). See Figure 9. 5. A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow. REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED IN ACTUATION GAS LINE LENGTH TOTALS FIGURE 8 I I REGULATED ACTUATOR REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED IN COMBINED TOTALS REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED FIGURE 9RELEASEASSEMBLY INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE Continued) 4. Expellant Gas Line From The Regulated Release Assembly Install expellant gas line from the regulated release assembly regulator in the enclosure by completing the following steps: The regulated release assembly is shipped with a factory - installed regulator. The regulator has two 1/4 in. outlets, one at the back and one at the bottom. The bottom outlet con- nects the expellant gas hose to the agent tank which is mounted inside the enclosure. The back outlet is sealed with a 1/4 in. plug. Connect expellant gas hose to the agent tank mounted inside the enclosure. If a pressure switch is required, a 1/4 in. x 1/8 in. reducing fitting will be required for connection between the back regulator outlet and the pressure switch. See Figure 7. DOUBLE AND MULTIPLE TANK SYSTEMS: If the expellant gas piping is required because an additional tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly is being installed, the plug installed in the back outlet must be removed. (See Figure 6 for proper connections to the regulator.) 3. Pipe the 1/4 in. expellant gas line from the regulator back outlet through one of the knockouts provided in the enclosure. The total length of the expellant gas line from the regulated release assembly must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m) when using a "double -tank" nitrogen cartridge (Shipping Part No. 73022) or a 101-30 CO2 cartridge (Shipping Part No. 15851). See Figure 10. EXPELLANT GAS LINE MAXIMUM LENGTH - 30 FT. (9 m). MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS - 9 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY FIGURE 10 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-5 REV. 1 If an actuation gas line is connected to the regulated release assembly along with an expellant gas line, the total com- bined length of the gas lines must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m) when using a "double -tank" nitrogen cartridge (Shipping Part No. 73022) or a 101-30 CO2 cartridge (Shipping Part No. 15851). See Figure 9. 5. A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow. Expellant Gas Line From The Regulated Actuator Assembly Install expellant gas piping from the regulated actuator assembly regulator through the appropriate knockout in the enclosure by completing the following steps: 1. The regulated actuator is shipped with a factory -installed regulator. The regulator has two 1/4 in. outlets 1350 from each other. One outlet is sealed by a 1/4 in. plug and the other contains the expellant gas hose for the agent tank which will be mounted within the enclosure. Connect expel- lant gas hose to the agent tank that is mounted inside the enclosure. 2. Remove the 1/4 in. pipe plug from the regulator side outlet and pipe the 1/4 in. expellant gas line from the regulator through the knockout provided in the enclosure to a tank - enclosure or tank -bracket assembly. A maximum of one tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly is allowed per regulated actuator assembly. The maximum length of the expellant gas line from the regu- lated actuator to the tank -bracket assembly must not exceed 30 ft. (9 m). See Figure 11. 3. A total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one 901 elbow. EXPELLANT GAS LINE MAXIMUM LENGTH - 30 FT. (9 m). MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS - 9 REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY FIGURE 11 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-6 INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE Continued) Actuation Gas Line From 101 Remote Release(s) to Regu- lated Actuators Install actuation gas piping from the remote release(s) to the regulated actuators by completing the following: 1. Pipe the 1/4 in. actuation gas line from the 1/4 in. outlet in the remote release receiver, through the knockout provided in the top of the release enclosure, to each regulated actu- ator assembly. The maximum length of the actuation gas line from the remote release to all regulated actuators must not exceed 100 ft. (30.5). See Figure 12. 2. A maximum of nine tees and twenty elbows are allowed in the actuation piping. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow. See Figure 12. 3. A safety relief valve (Part No. 15677) must be installed in the actuation piping. See Figure 12. SAFETY RELIEF VALVE 9 TEES 20 ELBOWS MAXIMUM ) MAXIMUM 1/4 IN. ACTUATION LINE - 100 FT. (30.5 m) MAXIMUM f REMOTE RELEASE REGULATED AGENT MECHANISMS ACTUATOR TANK (5 MAXIMUM) WITH TANK FIGURE 12 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-7 INSTALLING THE DISTRIBUTION PIPING Before the following procedures can be completed, the piping design must already be determined; and the actuation and expel- lant gas lines from the regulated release, each regulated actu- ator, and each tank -enclosure or tank -bracket assembly should already be installed. These installation instructions are identical for single, double, and multiple -tank systems except for the quantity of tanks and hazard areas to be covered. General Piping Requirements 1. Use Schedule 40 black iron, chrome -plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings. NOTICE Do not use hot -dipped galvanized iron pipe or fittings in the agent distribution piping. 2. Before assembling the pipe and fittings, make certain all ends are carefully reamed and blown clear of chips and scale. Inside of pipe and fittings must be free of oil and dirt. 3. The distribution piping and fitting connections, located in the protected area, must be sealed with pipe tape. When applying pipe tape, start at the second male thread and wrap the tape (two turns maximum) clockwise around the threads, away from the pipe opening. NOTICE Do not allow tape to overlap the pipe opening as the pipe and nozzles could become plugged. Thread sealant or compound must not be used as it could plug the nozzles. 4. Distribution piping may be run independently or two agent tanks may be manifolded together and run to the predeter- mined hazard area. Only agent tanks expelled from the same cartridge may be manifolded. NOTICE Closely follow the piping requirements for each size system, as detailed in the "System Design" section, when installing distribution piping. Piping Installation 1. Starting at the tank, pipe directly from the union located on the tank adaptor. A reducing fitting may be necessary to conform to the distribution piping. 2. Based on the piping sketch developed in the "System Design" section of this manual, install the supply line and position the tees at points where branch lines must be installed. See Figure 13. r-------- L----------- i FIGURE 13 3. Run all branch lines to the hazard area and connect each nozzle. (Make certain all fittings are tight and all piping is securely bracketed.) The 1 WS and 1 NS nozzles can be aimed by slipping a 3/8 in. Schedule 40 pipe over the tip, moving the tip to the correct aiming point, and then wrench tightening the retaining ring. 4 All threaded connections located in the protected area, must be sealed with pipe tape. Tape should be applied to male threads only. Make certain tape does not extend over the end of the thread, as this could cause possible blockage of the agent distribution. 5. Before installing blow -off caps on nozzles, apply a small amount of Dow Corning No. 111 silicone grease across the opening in the nozzle tip and also a small amount coating the exterior of the blow -off cap. This will help keep cooking grease from building up on the cap. NOTICE When using a metal blow -off cap, make cer- tain the spring clip rotates freely on the metal cap. 6. Make certain a blow -off cap is in place over each nozzle tip. These blow -off caps are designed to keep grease from building -up on the nozzle orifice and inhibiting the agent flow. See Figure 14. I / FIGURE 14 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-8 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM Before the following procedures can be completed, the detec- tion design must already be completed. These installation instructions are identical for single, double, and multiple -tank systems except for the number of hazard areas to be covered. NOTICE Inform customer that fusible links should not be exposed to ammonia -based chemical cleaners or steam. 1. Based on the requirements listed in the "System Design" section, mount the detectors in their predetermined locations. 2. Run 1/2 in. conduit from the regulated release mechanism trip hammer assembly knockout hole to locations selected for mounting the detectors. When changing the direction of conduit, use only Ansul pulley elbows, except, at the top of the regulated release, it is acceptable to use the "Conduit Offset Assembly" (Part No. 79825). Ansul offers three styles of detector bracket assemblies. Part No. 56837 and 56838 are the "clip -on" style series and ter- minal detector assemblies. These detector assemblies use a "clip -on" style linkage assembly and do not require the wire rope to be threaded through the linkage assembly while it is being fed through the detection system. Part No. 15373 and 15375 are the "hinged" style series and terminal detector assemblies. These detector assem- blies use a detector linkage assembly which requires the wire rope to be threaded through each linkage assembly while the rope is being fed through the detection system. Part No. 417368 and 417369 are the "scissor" style series and terminal detector assemblies. These detector assem- blies use a detector linkage assembly which does not require the wire rope to be threaded through the linkage assembly while it is being fed through the detection system. Installing "Clip -On" Style Linkage 1. Secure the conduit to the detector bracket using the two 1/2 in. steel compression fittings on the series detector bracket or the single 1/2 in. steel compression fitting on the terminal detector bracket. See Figure 15. COMPRESSION FITTING NUT- 1/2 IN.STEEL COMPRESSION FITTING FIGURE 15 NOTICE Do not use zinc die cast compression con- nectors on the detection conduit lines as these will not withstand the normally high tempera- tures experienced in the plenum area. 2. For a terminal detector located in a duct or header opening, secure both sides of the detector bracket with conduit, as shown in Figure 16. FIGURE 16 3. Starting at the regulated release assembly, feed the wire rope through the hole in the regulated release mechanism locking clamp, allowing the excess wire rope to hang down. Do not tighten set screws in locking clamp at this time.) See Figure 17. FIGURE 17 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-9 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Installing "Clip -On" Style Linkage (Continued) 4. From the regulated release assembly, run the stainless steel wire rope through the conduit, pulley elbows and detector brackets to the terminal detector. NOTICE If wire rope requires splicing, make certain splice is at least 12 in. (30.5 cm) away from any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor to avoid interference. Feed the wire rope through the terminal detector bracket as shown in Figure 18 or as shown in Figure 19 if the ter- minal detector is mounted within a duct or header opening, and install the stop sleeve approximately 2 to 3 in. (5 to 8 cm) from the end of the wire rope. See Figure 20. Use the National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool (Stock No: 51-C-887) or equal to properly crimp the stop sleeve. FIGURE 18 FIGURE 19 2.3 IN. 5-8 cm) 6. To give a constant tension on the wire rope during installa- tion of the detector linkage, hang a vice grip or other weighted device on the excess stainless steel wire rope, leaving an adequate length of spare wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device. NOTICE When attaching the weighted device to the excess wire rope, allow approximately 3 in. (8 cm) of wire rope for each detector linkage for proper installation. Example: If the system has six detectors, there should be approximately 18 in. (46 cm) of excess wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device, which will be utilized when the linkage is put in place. 7. Starting at the terminal detector, place the small tab of the detector linkage onto the wire rope. See Figure 21. FIGURE 21 8. With the tab positioned on the wire rope, press and snap the detector linkage onto the wire rope. See Figure 22. FIGURE 20 FIGURE 22 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-10 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Installing "Clip -On" Style Linkage (Continued) 9. Place the tab of the other half of the detector linkage on the opposite side of the wire rope and press the linkage until it snaps onto the rope. See Figure 23. FIGURE 23 NOTICE The hook portions of the detector linkage should now face away from each other. 10. Next, rotate both halves of the detector linkage upsidedown, with the detector linkage groove over the wire rope. See Figure 24. FIGURE 24 11. After fitting the pivot point of the two detector linkage halves together, squeeze the two halves and place the correctly rated Ansul approved fusible link over both detector hooks. See Figure 25. 12. Position the assembled linkage onto the detector bracket. See Figure 26. (For optimum detection, make certain the solder joint is in the down position.) BRACKET T FIGURE 26 NOTICE When positioning the linkage in the bracket, it is recommended to locate the linkage slightly off center, toward the terminal detector side. 13. Install the linkage and the correct Ansul approved fusible link in the remainder of the detector brackets. 14. Insert cocking lever (Part No. 14995) on left side of the regu- lated release mechanism, with the movable flange resting securely against the corner of the cartridge receiver and spring housing, and with the notched lever portion engaging the cocking pin on both sides of the regulated release mech- anism. See Figure 27. COCKIN ING PIN FIGURE 27 FIGURE 25 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-11 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Installing "Clip -On" Style Linkage (Continued) 15. With a downward motion of the cocking lever, raise cocking pin until the trip lever indented surface moves underneath the pin and locks the pin in the up position. See Figure 28. FIGURE 28 16. Remove cocking lever and insert lock bar (Part No. 14985) on left side of the cable lever, over the two shouldered projecting stud extensions, and slide bar forward into locking position. (The regulated release mechanism cannot be actu- ated, nor can enclosure cover be replaced until the lock bar is removed.) See Figure 29. WON-. iR ILY INSTALLED FIGURE 29 17. Make certain tension lever is in the "UP" position. See Figure 30. TENSION LEVER IN "UP" POSITION FIGURE 30 18. Verity each detector linkage assembly, with correct fusible link, is in the detector bracket, located slightly toward the terminal detector side. NOTICE Due to the close adjustment between the trip hammer and cable lever assemblies, use only the particular fusible link(s) selected for instal- lation in each detector, including terminal detector, to ensure correct adjustment when performing Steps 19 and 20. 19. Raise trip hammer 3/8 in. to 1/2 in. (9.5 to 12.7 mm), pull all slack out of wire rope, and tighten set screws on locking clamp. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 7-1-94 Page 5-12 REV. 1 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Installing "Clip -On" Style Linkage (Continued) 20. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position and inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clearance between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. See Figure 31. (If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever, loosen set screws on locking clamp and repeat Steps 19 and 20.) 114 IN. MINIMUM 6.4 mm) TRIP NAMMER BASE FIGURE 31 NOTICE Do not use zinc die cast compression con- nectors on the detection conduit lines as these will not withstand the normally high tempera- tures experienced in the plenum area. 2. For a terminal detector located in a duct or header opening, secure both sides of the detector bracket with conduit, as shown in Figure 33. Do not install cartridge at this time as an accidental actua- tion could caMuse system discharge. 3• 21. Test detection system in accordance with the "Testing and Placing in Service," Testing Detection System section of this manual. 22. When testing has been completed, cut off excess wire rope in the regulated release assembly, leaving approximately 2 in. (5.1 cm) of wire rope below the clamping device. Scissor" Style Linkage Installation 1. Secure the conduit to the detector bracket using the two 1/2 in. steel compression fittings on the series detector bracket or the single 1 /2 in. steel compression fitting on the terminal detector bracket. See Figure 32. COMPRESSION FITTING NUT 112 IN. STEEL COMPRESSION FITTING FIGURE 32 FIGURE 33 Starting at the release assembly, feed the wire rope through the hole in the release mechanism locking clamp, allowing the excess wire rope to hang down. (Do not tighten set screws in locking clamp at this time.) See Figure 34. FIGURE 34 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-13 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued) 4. From the release assembly, run the stainless steel wire rope through the conduit, pulley elbows and detector brackets to the terminal detector. NOTICE If wire rope requires splicing, make certain splice is at least 12 in. (30.5 cm) away from any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor to avoid interference. 5. Feed the wire rope through the terminal detector bracket as shown in Figure 35 or as shown in Figure 36 if the ter- minal detector is mounted within a duct or header opening, and install the stop sleeve approximately 2 to 3 in. (5 to 8 cm) from the end of the wire rope. See Figure 37. Use the National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool (Stock No. 51-C-887) or equal to properly crimp the stop sleeve. FIGURE 35 FIGURE 36 2-3 IN. 5-8 cm) FIGURE 37 6. To give a constant tension on the wire rope during installa- tion of the detector linkage, hang a vice grip or other weighted device' on the excess stainless steel wire rope, leaving an adequate length of spare wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device. NOTICE When attaching the weighted device to the excess wire rope, allow approximately 3 in. (8 cm) of wire rope for each detector linkage for proper installation. Example: If the system has six detectors, there should be approximately 18 in. (46 cm) of excess wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device, which will be utilized when the linkage is put in place. 7. Install detector scissor assembly as shown in Figure 38. Note that the ANSUL AUTOMAN release is located on the left side of the detector bracket. Slightly crimp the two assembly "boot -hooks" over the cable with pliers so the cable is captured under each hook but the whole assembly can move from side to side. Center the assembly in the detector bracket. FIGURE 38 B. Hook the fusible link on the ANSUL AUTOMAN release side of the hook assemby, then pull the fusible link to the oppo- site side and complete the hookup as shown in Figure 39 and 40. The top of the hook assembly must be inside the bracket stiffeners. The hook assembly with the fusible link in place must be located toward the terminal detector side of the bracket. GI/J Inc 9n FIGURE 40 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-14 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued) 9. Install the linkage and the correct Ansul approved fusible link in the remainder of the detector brackets. 10. Insert cocking lever (Part No. 14995) on left side of the release mechanism, with the movable flange resting securely against the corner of the cartridge receiver and spring housing, and with the notched lever portion engaging the cocking pin on both sides of the release mechanism. See Figure 41. cx PIN FIGURE 41 11. With a downward motion of the cocking lever, raise cocking pin until the trip lever indented surface moves underneath the pin and locks the pin in the up position. See Figure 42. FIGURE 42 12. Remove cocking lever and insert lock bar (Part No. 14985) on left side of the cable lever, over the two shouldered projecting stud extensions, and slide bar forward into locking position. (The release mechanism cannot be actuated, nor can enclosure cover be replaced until the lock bar is removed.) See Figure 43. 00K BAR 3ROPERLY NSTALLED FIGURE 43 13. Make certain tension lever is in the "UP" position. See Figure 44. TENSION LEVER IN " LIP"POSITION FIGURE 44 14. Verify each detector linkage assembly, with correct fusible link, is in the detector bracket, located fully toward the ter- minal detector side. NOTICE Due to the close adjustment between the trip hammer and cable lever assemblies, use only the particular fusible link(s) selected for instal- . lation in each detector, including terminal detector, to ensure correct adjustment when performing Steps 15 and 16. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-15 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued) 15. Raise trip hammer 3/8 in. to 1/2 in. (9.5 to 12.7 mm), pull all slack out of wire rope, and tighten set screws on locking clamp. 16. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position and inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clearance between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. See Figure 45. (If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever, loosen set screws on locking clamp and repeat Steps 15 and 16.) 114 IN. (6.4 mm) MINIMUM TRIP HAMMER BASE FIGURE 45 CAUTION Do not install cartridge at this time as an accidental actu- ation could cause system discharge. 17. Test detection system in accordance with the Testing and Placing in Service Section, Page 7-1 — 7-3, of this manual. 18. When testing has been completed, cut off excess wire rope in the regulated release assembly, leaving approximately 2 in. (5.1 cm) of wire rope below the clamping device. Installing "Hinged" Style Linkage 1. Secure the conduit to the detector bracket using 1/2 in. steel compression fittings. Thread the compression fitting into the detector bracket and then secure by using the lock nut sup- plied with the fitting. See Figure 46. 1/2 IN. STEEL COMPRESSION RT/TINGS 1/2 IN. COMPRESSION/ FITTING NUT FIGURE 46 2. NOTICE Do not use zinc die cast compression con- nectors on the detection conduit lines as zinc will not withstand the normally high tempera- tures experienced in the plenum area. Starting at the regulated release assembly, feed wire rope up through hole in regulated release mechanism locking clamp, allowing excess wire rope to hang down. (Do not tighten set screws in locking clamp at this time.) See Figure 47. r LAMP FIGURE 47 3. From the regulated release assembly, run the stainless steel wire rope through the conduit, pulley elbows and to the first detector. 4. Before continuing on past the detector bracket, feed the wire rope through the detector linkage assembly. See Figure 48. 5. Continue running the wire rope through the conduit and pulley elbows and feed it through each detector linkage assembly at each additional bracket. 6. At the terminal detector, feed wire rope through the terminal detector clamping device. Allow 2-3 in. (5-8 cm) of wire rope to extend beyond the clamping device and wrench tighten the set screws. See Figure 48. 2-3 IN. 5—B cm) FIGURE 48 7. To give a constant tension on the wire rope during posi- tioning of the detector linkage(s), hang a vise grip or other weighted device on the excess stainless steel wire rope, leaving an adequate length of spare wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-16 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) Installing "Hinged" Style Linkage (Continued) NOTICE When attaching the weighted device to the excess wire rope, allow approximately 3 in. (8 cm) of wire rope for each detector linkage for proper installation. Example: If the system has six detectors, there should be approximately 18 in. (46 cm) of excess wire rope between the locking clamp and the weighted device, which will be utilized when the linkage is put in place. 8. Starting at the terminal detector, squeeze the linkage together and place the correctly rated Ansul approved fusible link over both detector hooks. For optimum detec- tion, make certain the solder joint is in the down position. Locate the linkage in the center of the detector bracket. See Figure 49. Eurt.i i o F:W,:,A ICI FIGURE 49 9. Proceed to install the remainder of the Ansul approved fusible links on the detector hooks and position the linkage in the center of each bracket. 10. Insert cocking lever (Part No. 14995) on left side of regu- lated release mechanism with the movable flange resting securely against the corner of cartridge receiver and spring housing, with the notched lever portion engaging the cocking pin on both sides of the regulated release. See Figure 50. COCK CING PIN FIGURE 50 11. With a downward motion of the cocking lever, raise the cocking pin until trip hammer indented surface moves underneath the pin. See Figure 51. FIGURE 51 12. Remove the cocking lever and insert lock bar (Part No. 14985) on left side of cable lever, over the two shouldered projecting stud extensions, and slide the bar forward into the locking position. (The regulated release mechanism cannot be actuated, nor can enclosure cover be replaced until the lock bar is removed.) See Figure 52. BAR ERLY INSTALLED FIGURE 52 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-17 INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued) TRIP Installing "Hinged" Style Linkage (Continued) 13. Make certain tension lever is in the "UP" position. See Figure 53. TENSION LEVER IN "UP" POSITION FIGURE 53 14. Verify each detector linkage assembly, with correct fusible link, is approximately centered in the detector bracket. NOTICE Due to the close adjustment between the trip hammer and cable lever assemblies, use only the particular fusible link(s) selected for the installation in each detector, including the ter- minal detector, to ensure correct adjustment when performing Steps 15 and 16. 15. Raise trip hammer 3/8 in. to 1/2 in. (9.5 to 12.7 mm), pull all slack out of wire rope, and tighten set screw on locking clamp. 16. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position and inspect the base of wire rope clamping device to make certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clearance between the base of trip hammer assembly and cable lever assembly. See Figure 54. (If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever, loosen set screws on locking clamp and repeat Steps 15 and 16.) 1/4 IN. MINIMUM 6.4 mm) TRIP HAMMER BASE FIGURE 54 CAUTION Do not install cartridge or do not remove lock bar at this time as an accidental actuation could cause system discharge. 17. Test detection system in accordance with the "Testing and Placing in Service," Testing Detection System section of this manual. 18. When all testing has been completed in the "Testing and Placing in Service" section, cut off excess wire rope in the regulated release assembly, leaving approximately 2 in. 5.1 cm) of wire rope below the clamping device. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-18 REV. 1 INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION To install a remote manual pull station complete the following steps: 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached and lock bar is properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release assembly is in the cocked position. If regulated release assembly does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. 3. Select a convenient location in the path of exit for mounting the pull station(s) to the wall. Height and location of pull sta- tion should be determined in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. The total length of the wire rope used for each manual pull station within a system must not exceed 150 ft. (46 m). The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used per system is 20 of Part No. 45771 or 415670. Exception: When using a pulley tee, Part No. 15342, in the pull station line, the maximum length of wire rope to each pull station must not exceed 125 ft. (38 m) and the max- imum number of elbows must not exceed 18. 4. If junction box(es) is used, fasten a 4 in. (10 cm) junction box to wall or in wall where pull station is to be mounted, with mounting screws positioned so that when pull station cover is positioned in place, the printing will appear right side up and readable. ALTERNATE METHOD OF CONNECTION: a. Thread 3/4 x 1/2 in. reducing coupling to bushing on back of each cover assembly. b. Mount pull station cover(s) directly to wall at selected location so that printing is right side up and readable. 5. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit, pulley tee (if required), and pulley elbows from each pull station to regulated release assembly as necessary. See Figure 55 or 56. If a pulley tee is used, it must be installed between the regu- lated release assembly and first pulley elbow. The ambient temperature range of the pulley tee is between 32 OF to 130 OF (0 °C to 54 °C). REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION SINGLE APPLICATION O° PULLEY ELBOW WIRE ROPE RELEASE OVAL SLEEVE MECHANISM CABLE / LEVER f REMOTE ` MANUAL PULL LOCK BAR STATION BREAK ROD PULL IISIDESTUD g RING JUNCTION BOX HANDLE NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) FIGURE 55 REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION DUAL APPLICATION PULLEY TEE PULLEY EL/BOW OVAL SLEEVE RELEASE MECHANISM CABLEEVER I LOCK BAR JUNCTION BOX REMOTE NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) MANUAL PULL STATION FIGURE 56 6. Feed wire rope from each pull station through conduit and each pulley elbow to cable lever located at regulated release assembly. NOTICE Make certain that wire rope rides on top and in center of pulley sheave. If the 50 ft. (15 m) wire rope has been spliced to accommodate a longer run, do not allow the spliced ends to be within 12 in. (30 cm) of any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor. 7. Fasten pull station assembly to each junction box (if junc- tion box is used). 8. Slide oval crimp sleeve onto wire rope. Loop wire rope through cable lever guide holes and back through the oval crimp sleeve. See Figure 55. 9. Pull slack out of each wire rope and crimp sleeve. (Use the National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop sleeve.) See Figure 55. INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION (Continued) Molded Plastic Style To install a remote manual pull station complete the following steps: 1. Make certain the regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached and lock bar is properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. See Figure 57. I BAR ERLYINSTALLED FIGURE 57 NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and regulated release assembly is in the cocked position. 3. Select a convenient location in the path of exit for mounting the pull station(s) to the wall. Height and location of pull sta- tion should be determined in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. The total length of the wire rope used for each manual pull station within a system must not exceed 150 ft. (45.7 m). The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used per system is 20 of the high temperature pulley elbows, Part No. 45771. This is the only style elbow approved for use with this pull station. Exception: When using a pulley tee, Part No. 15342, in the pull station line, the maximum length of wire rope to each pull station must not exceed 125 ft. (38 m) and the max- imum number of elbows must not exceed 18. 4. Pull station can be surface mounted or flush mounted. In either case, a 4 in., octagonal, Raco No. 165 or equal junc- tion box must be used. This style junction box is 2 1/8 in. 5.4 cm) deep, which is required for proper installation of this type pull station. If flush mounted, the junction box must stick out 1/4 to 5/16 in. (.6 to .8 cm) from the finished wall surface to accommodate the trim ring and cover. See Figure 58. The trim ring is used only when the pull station is flush mounted to cover up the hole cut in the wall. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-19 REV. 1 114 - 5/181N. 8 - .8 Cm) FINISHED WALL PULL STATION MOUNTING HOLE UPPER RIGHT) MOUNTING HOLES CAN ALSO BE LOCATED IN UPPER LEFT AND LOWER RIGHT PULL STATION MOUNTING HOLE (LOWER LEFT) FIGURE 58 5. Mount the junction box. Location of mounting holes for pull station cover can be either in the upper right and lower left or upper left and lower right. See Figure 58. 6. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit, pulley tee (if required), and pulley elbow(s) from each pull station to the regulated release assembly as necessary. See Figure 59. Do not exceed maximum length of wire rope or maximum number of elbows. PULLEY ELBOW OVAL SLEEVE CABLE LEVER JI LOCK BAR 4 JUNCTION BOX RELEASE NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) MECHANISM PULLEY TEE PULLEY ELBOW JUNCTION BOX NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) FIGURE 59 If a pulley tee is used, it must be installed between the regu- lated release assembly and the first pulley elbow. Select the two mounting bosses on the back of the cover which match up with the mounting holes on the junction box and drill out the blind hole, using a 3/16 diameter drill bit. Attach pull station cover and trim ring (if necessary) to junc- tion box using two, 8-32 x 3/8 in. (.9 cm) long screws (sup- plied with junction box). Make certain wording on cover is oriented in the correct position. See Figure 60. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS U L EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-20 INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION (Continued) Molded Plastic Style (Continued) DRILL OUT BLIND HOLE IN MOUNTING BOSSES USING 3/16 IN. DIAMETER DRILL BIT r 6-32z3!6IN. LONG SCREWS (2) FIGURE 60 8. Feed wire rope from pull station location through conduit and each pulley elbow to the cable lever located in the regu- lated release assembly. NOTICE Make certain the wire rope rides on top and in the center of each pulley sheave. If the wire rope has been spliced, do not allow the spliced ends to be within 12 in. (30 cm) of any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor. 9. Slide oval crimp sleeve, Part No. 4596, over end of wire rope and then loop end of wire rope in groove around pull ring. Insert end of rope through sleeve, snug tightly around pull ring and crimp sleeve. See Figure 61. (Use the National Tel- ephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop sleeve.) PULL RING 1 STOP SLEEVE PART NO. 4596 FIGURE 61 10. At the release mechanism, slide oval crimp sleeve onto wire rope. Loop wire rope through cable lever guide holes and back through the oval sleeve. Pull all but 1 to 2 in. (2.5 to 5.1 cm) of slack out of wire rope and crimp sleeve. See Figure 59. (Use the National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop sleeve.) Cut off excess wire rope. 11. At the pull station, position pull ring vertically in pull station cover, insert break -away seal, Part No. 79029, through holes in cover and snap in place. See Figure 62. SNAP IN PLACE ICE INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE FIGURE 62 To install each Mechanical Gas Shut-off Valve complete the fol- lowing steps. (All gas valve installation and testing shall be made in accordance with the authority having jurisdiction.) 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached and lock bar is properly inserted in the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. 3. Remove plug from cartridge receiver. See Figure 63. CARTRIDGE RECEIVER Q ® PLUG FIGURE 63 SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-21 INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued) 4. Locate air cylinder and bracket assembly over the two 7/32 in. (.6 cm) holes,on right side of the enclosure. Assemble with screws, lockwashers, and nuts. Wrench tighten. See Figure 64. Air cylinder(s) can also be mounted in the inverted position, allowing for direct exit out the knockout(s) in the bottom of the enclosure. See Figure 65. FOR MOUNTING ONE MECHANICAL GAS VALVE 1/8 IN. COPPER TUBING AND FITTINGS TOP KNOCKOL BOTTOM KNOCKOUTS SLEEVE MOUNTING BRACKET FIGURE 64 DP SLEEVES AIR CYLINDER RODS MOUNTING BRACKETS R TUBING 5 FIGURE 66 6. Install the necessary 1/8 in. copper tubing and fittings for each air cylinder to the accessories piping arrangement on the regulated release mechanism. See Figures 64 and 66. NOTICE Do not kink 1/8 in. copper tubing or form a bend too close to a fitting. Secure each fitting IANICAL without over tightening. Over tightening could VALVE result in pressure leakage or line separationYLINDER at actuation. 7. To reduce th7risk of explosion due to leaking gas, make certain that as line is turned off before connectingthegasvalv Install mechanical gas valve to its selected location in gas line so that it ensures safe shut-off to all predetermined appliances being protected upon actuation of the system. kTED RELEASE Mechanical gas valves may be mounted in any convenient horizontal or vertical position. See Figure 67. FIGURE 65 If two mechanical gas valves are being attached, complete Step 5. If not, go to Step 6. 5. To install second mechanical gas valve shut-off system, locate second air cylinder and bracket assembly adjacent to first assembly and over the two remaining 7/32 in.(.6 cm) holes provided on right side of the enclosure. Assemble second cylinder with screws, lockwashers, and nuts as required. Wrench tighten. See Figure 66. a. Use new pipe, properly reamed and cleaned of metal chips. b. Make certain gas flow is in the same direction as arrow shown on gas valve. To avoid cracking the gas valve casting, do not overtighten pipe connections. If pipe tape, paste, spray, or similar lubricant is used, extra care should be taken to avoid overtightening. Apply lubricant to male threads only. c. Wrench tighten pipe to gas valve. DO NOT USE GAS VALVE AS A LEVER WHEN INSTALLING OR VALVE DAMAGE MAY OCCUR. See Figure 67. d. If strainer is utilized, attach strainer ahead of gas valve. e. If necessary, install drip leg in gas line in accordance with the authority having jurisdiction. f. The total length of wire rope allowed for each valve must not exceed 150 ft. (46 m). g. The maximum number of pulley elbows allowed for each gas valve is 20. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-22 INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued) ANSUL MECHANICAL GAS VALVES CORRECT WAY: VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. CORRECT WAY: WRENCH APPLIED NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. ASCO MECHANICAL GAS VALVES CORRECT WAY: VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. WRONG WAY: WRENCH APPLIED AT THIS POINT STRAINS VALVE BODY. r CORRECT WAY: WRENCH APPLIED NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. WRONG WAY: WRENCH APPLIED AT THIS POINT STRAINS VALVE BODY. 8. Install 1/2 in. conduit, and pulley elbow(s) from the mechan- ical gas valve to regulated release assembly enclosure as necessary. 9. Beginning at the regulated release assembly, thread the end of the wire rope through hole provided in air cylinder rod. See Figure 64. 10. Feed end of wire rope through conduit and each pulley elbow. Make certain that wire rope rides on top and in center of pulley sheave. If the 50 ft. (15 m) wire rope has been spliced to accommodate a longer run, do not allow the spliced ends to be within 12 in. (30 cm) of any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor. 11. Remove side cover on gas valve and thread end of wire rope through hole in cocking lever. Slide stop sleeve (Part No. 26317) on to wire rope and crimp. (Use the National Tele- phone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop sleeve.) Make cer- tain crimp is on top of cocking lever, with wire rope curled under lever. See Figure 68. E COCKING LEVER FIGURE 68 12. With the end of wire rope already threaded through hole in air cylinder rod, slide stop sleeve (Part No. 26317) onto wire rope and leave loose. Do not crimp stop sleeve at this time. See Figure 64. FIGURE 67 INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued) 13. Cock mechanical gas valve as shown in Figure 69 ANSUL MECHANICAL GAS VALVE COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION ASCO MECHANICAL GAS VALVE COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION FIGURE 69 14. Raise air cylinder rod "UP" to its maximum extended posi- tion. See Figure 64. 15. Manually pull wire rope to remove excess slack. NOTICE DO NOT ACTUATE THE MECHANICAL GAS VALVE. Each Mechanical Gas Valve System must have gas valve cocked and air cylinderIf rod extended "UP" to its maximum extension before completing next step. 16. Slide stop sleeve against air cylinder rod, make certain all slack is removed from wire, and crimp stop sleeve. See Figure 64. 17. Cut off any excess wire rope approximately 3/4 in. (2 cm) from end of stop sleeve. 18. NOTE: If utilizing a pulley tee to operate a single mechan- ical gas valve from two (2) ANSUL AUTOMAN releases, see Figure 69a for installation instructions. Maximum length of wire rope to each ANSUL AUTOMAN release must not exceed 125 ft. (38 m) and maximum number of elbows must not exceed 18. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 5-23 REV. 1 TO "ANSUL AUTOMAN" RELEASE NUMBER 1 12 IN. (31 cm) 1FROMSLEEVE PART NO. 24918 TO PULLEY TEE PART NO. 15342 2 IN. (5 cm) FROM SLEEVE TO COMPRESSION FrrrING TO "ANSUL AUTOMAN" RELEASE NUMBER 2 NO PULLEY ELBOWS BETWEEN TEE AND VALVE FIGURE 69a INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES The following instructions and schematics illustrate methods of procedures for installing 110 VAC Electric Gas Shut-off Valves. 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached and lock bar is properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. 3. CAUTION To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, make certain that the gas line is turned off before connecting the gas valve. Install each electric gas valve to its selected location in gas line so that it ensures safe shut-off to all predetermined appliances being protected upon actuation of the system. Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided). See Figure 70. a. Use new pipe properly reamed and clean of metal chips. b. Install valve so that the actuator is above the horizontal pipe line with no more than a five degree (50) lean either way. c. Make certain gas flow is in the same direction as arrow shown on gas valve. d. If strainer is utilized, attach strainer ahead of gas valve. e. If necessary, install drip leg in gas line in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-24 INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES (Continued) CORRECT WAY: VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. CORRECT WAY: WRONG WAY: WRENCH PIPE BEO PREVENT ON VALVI T THIS VE BODY FIGURE 70 4. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from each electric gas valve to manual reset relay enclosure. 5. Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric gas valve. Then, feed wire through conduit to manual reset relay. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. Refer to Figures in Design" section for typical wiring diagrams. 6. Q • Before working on any electrical wiring, make certain main power has been disconnected. Failure to discon- nect main power could cause personal injury or death if contact is made with energized wires. Connect electrical wiring to manual reset relay along with any contactor, or contractor supplied devices needed. Refer to manufacturer's instructions and proper figure listed for assistance. 7. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accord- ance with authority having jurisdiction. 8. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from the regulated release assembly enclosure to manual reset relay enclosure. If snap -action switches have not been attached, go to "Elec- tric Switch" section on Page 5 — 24 and install them at this time by completing Steps 3 through 8. 9. Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric (snap - action) switch. Then, feed wire through conduit to manual reset relay. 10. Connect wiring from each electric (snap -action) switch to manual reset relay terminals. Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided) and proper figure for assistance. 11. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accord- ance with authority having jurisdiction. 12. Properly return electrical power to the system. INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES The procedure for field installing an electric (snap -action) switch is as follows: 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached with lock bar properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8 —1, in "Main- tenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. If regulated release mechanism has a factory installed sole- noid, it will also have a factory installed switch. 3. Press each 3-wire plug assembly into the 3-terminals located on the switch. Be sure that the plug is pressed tight against the switch. See Figure 71. SNAP -ACTION SWITCH RED L_ BLACK O BROWN tPRESS PLUG WIRE PLUG ACTUATING ARM TIGHTLY AGAINST SWITCH TERMINALS FIGURE 71 4. Insert fastening screws into switch. If switch (Part No. 32220, Four -Pole, Double -Throw or Part No. 415868, 3 pole, Double -Throw) is being used, skip Step 4 and proceed to Step 5. See Figure 72. Switches, Part No. 15549 and 32222, are provided with two No.4-40 self -tapping screws. Switch, Part No. 415868, is provided with two No. 4-40 x 1 1/2 in. long machine screws and two No. 4-40 Hex Nuts. Switch, Part No. 32220, is provided with two No. 4-40 x 2 in. long machine screws and two No. 4-40 hex nuts. 5. To install the three -pole, double -throw switch, Part No. 415868, or the four -pole, double -throw switch, Part No. 32220, it will be necessary to enlarge the bracket mounting holes on the regulated release mechanism. The mounting holes are intended for self -tapping screws. Either drill the holes using No. 33 (1/8 in.) drill bit or tap out holes with a No. 4-40 tap. See Figure 72. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-23 INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued) 13. Cock mechanical gas valve as shown in Figure 69. ANSUL MECHANICAL GAS VALVE COCKING LEVER COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION ASCO MECHANICAL GAS VALVE KII R COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION FIGURE 69 14. Raise air cylinder rod "UP" to its maximum extended posi- tion. See Figure 64. 15. Manually pull wire rope to remove excess slack. NOTICE DO NOT ACTUATE THE MECHANICAL GAS VALVE. Each Mechanical Gas Valve System must have gas valve cocked and air cylinder rod extended "UP" to its maximum extension before completing next step. 16. Slide stop sleeve against air cylinder rod, make certain all slack is removed from wire, and crimp stop sleeve. See Figure 64. 17. Cut off any excess wire rope approximately 3/4 in. (2 cm) from end of stop sleeve. INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES The following instructions and schematics illustrate methods of procedures for installing 110 VAC Electric Gas Shut-off Valves. 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached and lock bar is properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verity that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. 3. Lt, • rgas e risk of explosion du7tolea7king gas, makehegaslineisturnedconnecting e. Install each electric gas valve to its selected location in gas line so that it ensures safe shut-off to all predetermined appliances being protected upon actuation of the system. Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided). See Figure 70. a. Use new pipe properly reamed and clean of metal chips. b. Install valve so that the actuator is above the horizontal pipe line with no more than a five degree (50) lean either way. c. Make certain gas flow is in the same direction as arrow shown on gas valve. d. If strainer is utilized, attach strainer ahead of gas valve. e. If necessary, install drip leg in gas line in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-24 INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES (Continued) CORRECT WAY: VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY. \ CORRECT WAY: WRENCH PIPE BEU PREVENT ON VALVI WRONG WAY: T THIS VE BODY FIGURE 70 4. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from each electric gas valve to manual reset relay enclosure. 5. Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric gas valve. Then, feed wire through conduit to manual reset relay. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accordance with authority having jurisdiction. Refer to Figures in Design" section for typical wiring diagrams. 6. Before working on any electrical wiring, make certain main power has been disconnected. Failure to discon- nect main power could cause personal injury or death if contact is made with energized wires. Connect electrical wiring to manual reset relay along with any contactor, or contractor supplied devices needed. Refer to manufacturer's instructions and proper figure listed for assistance. 7. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accord- ance with authority having jurisdiction. 8. Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from the regulated release assembly enclosure to manual reset relay enclosure. If snap -action switches have not been attached, go to "Elec- tric Switch" section on Page 5 — 24 and install them at this time by completing Steps 3 through 8. 9. Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric (snap - action) switch. Then, feed wire through conduit to manual reset relay. 10. Connect wiring from each electric (snap -action) switch to manual reset relay terminals. Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided) and proper figure for assistance. 11. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accord- ance with authority having jurisdiction. 12. Properly return electrical power to the system. INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES The procedure for field installing an electric (snap -action) switch is as follows: 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached with lock bar properly inserted within the regulated release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. Verity that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that the regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Main- tenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. If regulated release mechanism has a factory installed sole- noid, it will also have a factory installed switch. 3. Press each 3-wire plug assembly into the 3-terminals located on the switch. Be sure that the plug is pressed tight against the switch. See Figure 71. SNAP -ACTION SWITCH RED BLACK O '- - BROWN PRESS PLUG WIRE PLUG ACTUATING ARM TIGHTLY AGAINST SWITCH TERMINALS FIGURE 71 4. Insert fastening screws into switch. If switch (Part No. 32220, Four -Pole, Double -Throw or Part No. 415868, 3 pole, Double -Throw) is being used, skip Step 4 and proceed to Step 5. See Figure 72. Switches, Part No. 15549 and 32222, are provided with two No.4-40 self -tapping screws. Switch, Part No. 415868, is provided with two No. 4-40 x 1 1/2 in. long machine screws and two No. 4-40 Hex Nuts. Switch, Part No. 32220, is provided with two No. 4-40 x 2 in. long machine screws and two No. 4-40 hex nuts. 5. To install the three -pole, double -throw switch, Part No. 415868, or the four -pole, double -throw switch, Part No. 32220, it will be necessary to enlarge the bracket mounting holes on the regulated release mechanism. The mounting holes are intended for self -tapping screws. Either drill the holes using No. 33 (1/8 in.) drill bit or tap out holes with a No. 4-40 tap. See Figure 72. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-25 INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES (Continued) FOR SNAP -ACTION SWITCH, PART NO. 15549 OR 32222 FOR SNAP -ACTION SWITCH, PART NO. 32220 TRIP LEVER --4J EXTENSION STUD 1NTING CKET SNAP -ACTION SWITCH LOCKWASHER 10 MOUNTING BRACKET SNAP -ACTION SWITCHES FIGURE 72 6. Install switch to the mounting bracket and tighten securely. 7. Raise switch actuating arm squarely over the cam surface of the trip lever. This will allow the trip lever, when actu- ated, to force the actuating arm "UP", thus reversing the normal condition of the switch. See Figure 73. For switch, Part No. 15549, use screw, Part No. 415870, and nut, Part No. 21918, on trip lever. For switch, Part No. 32222, 415868, and 32220, use the trip lever cam extension stud that is provided. Before proceeding with Step 8, test electric (snap -action) switches: a. Remove lock bar. With the ANSUL AUTOMAN in the cocked or ready position, press the lever of each switch up. If the switch is working properly there should be an audible click. b . With the ANSUL AUTOMAN in the fired position, press the lever of each switch up, there should be no audible click. c . If an audible click is heard in the fired position several adjustments can be made. The trip lever extension pin can be rotated so the peak of one of the hex points is pointed up against the switch levers. Tighten it in that position. If this doesn't resolve the problem, loosen the screws holding the switches, apply a small counter- clockwise torque on the switches and retighten the screws. If necessary, a final adjustment can be made by removing the snap action switch and bending the lever slightly. d. After adjustments repeat steps a and b. Then, recock ANSUL AUTOMAN and install lock bar. ACTUATING ARM TRIP LEVER CAM O p O DUAL SNAP -ACTION SWITCH PART NO. 32222 SNAP -ACTION SWITCH PART NO. 15549 m m O O TRIP LEVER EXTENSION STUD TWO DUAL SNAP -ACTION SWITCHES PART NO. 32M FIGURE 73 8. The switch may now be connected to compatible compo- nents that are predetermined to shut off or turn on. Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided) for proper wiring connections to compatible components. 9. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accord- ance with authority having jurisdiction. NOTICE Do not connect power source to any relay, contactor, or contractor supplied devices until all other electrical connections are made. Refer to proper section or manufacturer sup- plied instructions for recommended installa- tion procedures for these devices. 10. Turn off power source and connect power line to any relay, contactor, or contractor supplied devices where used. SECTION V — INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 5-26 INSTALLING PRESSURE SWITCH The procedure for field installing a pressure switch is as follows: 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure cover is detached with lock bar properly inserted within the release mechanism. NOTICE Failure to follow these instructions may lead to system actuation. 2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated release assembly and that regulated release mechanism is in the cocked position. If regulated release mechanism does not have lock bar inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi -Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the following installation steps. 3. Assemble pressure switch through knockout holes provided on right side of regulated release assembly enclosure and secure with a 1/2 in. nut, which is provided. See Figure 53. If two pressure switches are required, preassemble the switch enclosures using a 1/2 x 1 1/2 in. pipe nipple, 3/4 in. long spacer, and conduit nuts. The pipe nipple can be used as a wiring chaseway. See Figure 74. FOR MOUNTING ONE PRESSURE SWITCH 114 IN. TEE WITH 114 IN. x 118 IN.REDUCER C PIE 4I IN. NIP 4 N. LONG 118 IN. ELBOW PRESSURE SWITCH 1/ 8 IN. COPPER TUBING AND FITTINGS IN. NUT FOR MOUNTING TWO PRESSURE SWITCHES PRESSURE SWITCH HOUSING 114 IN. NIPPLE 4 IN. LONG 1/ 8 IN. ELBOW 112 1N. x 112 IN. NIPPLE, 314 IN. SPACER. 2 112 IN. NUTS 4. For single -tank systems, install a 1/8 in. reducing fitting in the top outlet of the regulator; double -tank systems require an additional 1/4 in. nipple (4 in. long) and a 1/4 in. tee for installation to the expellant gas piping. Attach remaining 1/8 in. fittings as required to facilitate piping requirements for each pressure switch that will be used. See Figure 74. NOTICE Do not kink 1/8 in. copper tubing or form a bend too close to a fitting. Secure each fitting without over tightening. Over tightening could result in pressure leakage or line separation at actuation. 5. Wire each pressure switch to other compatible components in accordance with manufacturer's instructions (if provided). A QUALIFIED ELECTRICIAN should connect all electrical components in accordance with authority having jurisdic- tion. See Figure 75. SINGLE - POLE PRESSURE SWITCH COMMON- 0 RESET SWITCH NORMALL' CLOSED DOUBLE - POLE PRESSURE SWITCH ONORMALLY OPEN6 O 0 COMMON RESET NORMALLY SWITCH CLOSED FEMALE CONNECTORS WIRE NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) FEMALE CONNECTORS WIRE NOT SUPPLIED BY ANSUL) I FIGURE 75 N 118 IN. TEE AND FITTINGS 1/ 4 IN. TEE WITH 114 IN. x 1/8 IN.REDUCER FIGURE 74 SECTION VI — TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 6-1 a After the system has been completely installed, and BEFORE INSTALLING THE CARTRIDGE, the system must be tested at the regulated release assembly. TESTING MANUAL PULL STATION To test each remote manual pull station, complete the following steps: 1. With the expellant gas cartridge removed, remove lock bar from regulated release assembly cable lever. 2. On metal stamped pull station, remove glass break rod from pull station by removing set screw on side of stud and slide glass break rod out. On molded plastic pull station, seal will be broken during test and must be replaced. 3. Pull ring handle on pull station. If the regulated release assembly is tripped easily, the remote manual pull station is properly installed. If the regulated release assembly does not trip, remove pulley tee (if provided) and each pulley elbow cover to make certain wire rope is resting on the pulley sheave. If this does not correct the problem, there is too much slack in the line and it must be retightened. 4. Cut off any excess wire rope 3/4 in. (2 cm) above oval sleeve. 5. Recock regulated release assembly using cocking lever Part No. 14995) and reinstall lock bar (Part No. 14985) 6. On metal stamped pull station, slide glass break rod through stud and ring handle. Tighten set screw into stud. On molded plastic pull station, replace seal. NOTICE If no other devices are being attached, pro- ceed to Page 6-4, Step No. 1, and test the detection system. TESTING MECHANICAL GAS VALVES To test each mechanical gas shut-off valve complete the fol- lowing steps: 1. A To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical or mechanical devices that are capable of igniting gas. Turn gas line on. 2. Manually push each air cylinder rod to full "DOWN" posi- tion. The gas valve should close. If mechanical gas valve does not trip, remove each pulley elbow cover to make cer- tain wire rope is resting on each pulley elbow sheave. If this does not correct the problem there may be too much slack in the line and it should be retightened. 3. Test for gas leaks by painting connections with a soap solu- tion. Bubbles indicate a gas leak. Tighten connections where leaks appear and repeat test again to make certain no other gas leaks exist. 4. If no gas leak is found, pull air cylinder rod to full "UP" position. 5. Recock mechanical gas valve. 6. Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR EXISTS, MANUALLY PUSH THE AIR CYLINDER ROD TO THE FULL "DOWN" POSITION IMMEDIATELY. This will cause the mechanical gas valve to shut the gas line off. Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding any further. 7. If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this time. 8. Reinstall side covers to gas valve housing. Make certain roll pin is positioned within both sides of the valve housing slot. Connect visual inspection seals (Part No. 197) on Ansul type valves. See Figure 1. SPECTION IT NO. 197) I;ILeITI7:1 9. Make certain the regulated release mechanism is cocked with lock bar in place. NOTICE If no other devices are being attached, pro- ceed to Page 6-4, Step No. 1, and test the detection system. SECTION VI — TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 6-2 TESTING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES TESTING ELECTRIC SWITCH To test each Electric Gas Shut-off Valve complete the following The procedure for testing a field installed Electric (Snap -Action) steps: Switch is as follows: 1. To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical or mechanical devices that are capable of igniting gas. Turn gas line on. 2. Make certain electric (snap -action) switch is properly wired. 3. Make certain all other devices connected to the manual reset relay are properly wired. Refer to typical wiring dia- grams in Figures 80, 81, and 82 in "Design" section. 4. Test for gas leaks by painting connections with a soap solu- tion. Bubbles indicate a gas leak. Tighten connections where leaks appear. Repeat test again to make certain no other gas leaks exist. 5. If no gas leaks are found, turn power source on and depress the reset button on the manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON) to energize (OPEN) electric gas valve. 6. Remove lock bar from regulated release mechanism. NOTICE If an electrical gas shut-off valve is attached to system, perform proper test procedure for the gas valve first, before completing the fol- lowing steps. 1. Turn power source on and if installed, depress reset button on manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON). All electrical devices should be operating at this time. 2. Remove lock bar. CAUTION Do not install cartridge at this time or system may be actuated. 3. CAUTION Do not install cartridge at this time or system may be actuated. 4 7. Manually actuate the system by operating the remote pull station. (It may be necessary to remove the glass break rod prior to operating pull station.) Manual reset relay (RED LIGHT OUT) will de -energize (CLOSE) the electric gas valve, thus shutting off the gas line. If this does not happen, turn power source off. Then re-examine all wiring connections for proper hookup. Refer to Figures 80, 81, and 82 in Design" section for typical wiring diagram. 8. If test is successful, recock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever (Part No. 14995) and reinstall lock bar Part No. 14985). Depress reset button on manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON). 9. Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR EXISTS, TURN OFF POWER SOURCE IMMEDIATELY. This will cause the electric gas valve to shut the gas line off. Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding any further. 10. If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this time. NOTICE If no other devices are being attached, pro- ceed to Page 6-4, Step No. 1, and test the detection system. Manually actuate the system by operating the remote pull station. It may be necessary to remove the glass break rod prior to operating pull station. (If installed, the manual reset relay will de -energize the electric gas valve, thus shutting off the gas line.) All electrically -operated devices predeter- mined to shut off or turn on should do so. If this does not occur, turn power source off and make sure all wiring is properly connected and retest. Refer to Figures 84, 85, and 86 in "Design" section for typical wiring diagram. If test is successful, recock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever (Part No. 14995) and reinstall lock bar Part No. 14985). If a manual reset relay is installed, depress the reset button (RED LIGHT ON). It will also be necessary to re -light any pilot lights on the cooking appliances. NOTICE If no other devices are being attached, pro- ceed to Page 6-4, Step No. 1, and test the detection system. SECTION VI — TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 6-3 C C TESTING PRESSURE SWITCH The procedures for testing a field installed pressure switch is as follows: NOTICE This test should only be performed by a OUALIFIED ELECTRICIAN. If an electrical gas shut-off valve is attached to system, perform proper test procedure for the gas valve first, before completing the fol- lowing steps. 1. Make certain power source is turned off. 2. Push each pressure switch reset button on front of switch housing assembly. An audible click may be heard at this time depending' on which condition the switch is in. See Figure 2. 0 10 RESET BUTTON FIGURE 2 3. Detach each pressure switch cover from housing assembly. 4. By use of an ohmmeter, verity that contacts are in their normal (READY) condition. Contact conditions are marked on switch. See Figure 3. NORMALLY OPEN CONTACT COMM( NORMALLY CLOSED CONTACT RESET SWITCH FIGURE 3 5. Manually lift up on each pressure plate or pressure nut. An audible click should be heard at this time. The sound veri- fies that the switch has transferred to an actuated condi- tion. See Figure 4. RESET RE PLATE FIGURE 4 6. By use of an ohmmeter, verity that contacts are in their actu- ated condition. (Normally open is now closed and normally closed is now open.) 7. Reattach pressure switch cover to housing assembly. 8. Push each reset button to resume normal (READY) condi- tion. An audible click should be heard at this time. 9. Turn power source on. 10. Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked with lock bar in place. NOTICE If no other devices are being attached, pro- ceed to Page 6-4, Step No. 1, and test the detection system. SECTION VI — TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 6-4 TESTING DETECTION SYSTEM 1. Test detection system by completing the following steps: a. Raise the regulated release mechanism tension lever to the "UP" position. b. Remove the fusible link from the terminal detector and install a test link (Part No. 15751). See Figure 5. O TEST LINK FIGURE 5 c. Locate detector linkage and center in each bracket. For "clip on" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket slightly toward termination end of detection run. For "scissor" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket all the way toward termination end of detection run. d. Lower regulated release mechanism tension lever to DOWN" position and remove lock bar. e. Using a wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detector to simulate automatic actuation. I. If system actuates successfully, go to Step 4. 2. If the regulated release mechanism does not actuate, check the following components and remedy any disorder as follows: a. Check the detector linkage for correct positioning. b. Check the wire rope for knotting or jamming. c. Check pulley elbows to see that wire rope is free and centered in pulley sheaves. If any evidence of pulley elbow deformation is found, replace the pulley elbow. d. Make certain that lock bar is removed. e. Make certain that regulated release mechanism is cocked. I. Make certain that tension lever is in "DOWN" position. 3. Re -test the system by completing the following steps: a. Make certain regulated release is cocked and lock bar is inserted. b. Raise the regulated release mechanism tension lever to the "UP" position. c: Install a new test link (Part No. 15751) on the terminal detector. d. Lower the regulated release mechanism tension lever to the "DOWN" position. e. Check for 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum clearance between the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. I. Remove the lock bar. g. Using a wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detector to simulate automatic actuation. 4. Upon successful actuation of the system, complete the fol- lowing steps: a. Raise tension lever to "UP" position and install a properly -rated fusible link in the terminal detector. b. Cock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever Part No. 14995) and insert lock bar (Part No. 14985). c. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. d. Locate detector linkage and center in each bracket. For "clip on" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket slightly toward termination end of detection run. For "scissor" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket all the way toward termination end of detection run. e. Make certain the 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum clearance was maintained between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. NOTICE Reset any electrical equipment that may have been affected by the system actuation. I. Install appropriate cartridge into the regulated release mechanism receiver and each regulated actuator receiver. Hand tighten firmly. g. Remove the lock bar. h. Snap cover on regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly, insert visual seal (Part No. 197) in each upper and lower cover hole and secure. i. Record installation date on tag attached to unit and/or in a permanent file. B SECTION VII — RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 7-1 CFor continued fire protection, the R-102 restaurant fire sup- c. Install adaptor/tube assembly and tighten. pression system must be recharged immediately after use. d. At expellant gas line inlet to adaptor/tube assembly, Recharge procedures for single, double, and multiple -tank install a 1/4 in. male quick connect adaptor. systems are as follows. e. Connect nitrogen cylinder outlet hose to the male quick RECHARGE connect adaptor using the female portion of the adaptor assembly. NOTICE 7. To perform the flushing procedure, either secure heavy-duty Determine the cause of system discharge and plastic bags to each nozzle (See Figure 2) or remove each correct immediately before performing system nozzle tip and strainer and attach plastic tubing. See Figure recharge. 3.. If using plactic bags, secure bags and proceed to Step 9. 1. Remove the enclosure cover from the ANSUL AUTOMAN regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator If using plastic tubing, proceed to Step 8. assembly. HIGH PRESSURE VENT HOLES 2. From tank in regulated release enclosure: Disconnect the GAUGE SUPPLY / expellant gas hose from each tank adaptor assembly. NITROGEN REGULATOR LINE From tank in mounting bracket or mounting enclosure: Dis- VALVE ER LOW ~ connect expellant gas piping union at each tank adaptor / PRESSURJD GAUGENOZZLE inlet line(s). fFITTING 3. Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor ® i BALL VAL outlet line(s). ' K 4. From tank in enclosure: Remove tank. ONNECT From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage bracket band, and remove each tank. HEAVY GAUGE 5. Remove each tank adaptor/tube assembly. Remove O-ring NITROG N PLASTIC BAG C and inspect for damage. Clean and coat 0-ring with a good CYLINDER P 9 9 9 OUTLET HOSE grade of extreme temperature grease and reinstall into 285 PSI (1827 kPa) adaptor groove. See Figure 1. SAFETY VENT RELIEF VALVE FLUSHING TANK NITROGEN CYLINDER O-RING FIGURE 2 FIGURE 1 NOZZLE TIP NITROGEN AND RETAINER CYLINDER VALVE SUPPLY \\`\ NOZZLE BODY 6 -/ HIGH LINE \ PRESSURE REGULATOR Tf Do not flush pipe with only water or other non -approved GAUGE _ Fk'7 HIGH PRESSURE p p y PP Low PLASTIC TUBING material, as this could cause internal corrosion, leading PRESSURE to possible improper discharge. f GAUGE . TANK OUTLET BALL VALVE HOSE Piping system must be flushed to remove any wet Chem- /// OUICK ical residue. To prepare the system for flushing: DISCONNECT 112 IN. NPT COMPRESSION a. Pour the complete contents of one 4 oz. bottle of Ansul FITTING/THREADED ADAPTOR Flushing Concentrate (Part No. 79656) into an empty NITROGEN R-102 agent tank. One complete bottle is used for either CYLINDER size tank, the 1.5 gallon or the 3.0 gallon. HOSE b. Fill the tank approximately half full with warm, clean 265 PSI (1827 kPa) C water. Agitate the tank for a few seconds and then add SAFETY VENT g RELIEF VALVE more warm water to bring the fill level to within approx imately 1 in. (2.5 cm) from the bottom of the fill opening. NITROGEN CYLINDER t FLUSHING TANK FIGURE 3 SECTION VII — RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 7-2 REV. 1 RECHARGE (Continued) 8. If using the plastic tubing option, utilize 1/2 in. (1.3 cm) O.D. plastic tubing with wall thickness not to exceed .062 in. (1.6 mm), and make certain it can withstand the pressures of at least 90 PSI (620.6 kPa) expelled during the flushing and blowdown procedures. Also required is a container with some means of securing tubing to it such as a five -gallon plastic pail and cover that snaps onto the pail. To prepare the plastic tubing: a. Cut as many tubing lengths as required, making them long enough to reach the container from each nozzle outlet. b. Using a 1 N nozzle tip and retainer, (Part No. 56930), slide a length of 1/2 in. (1.3 cm) plastic tubing over the rib on the nozzle tip and secure with a 1/2 in. (1.3 cm) adjustable hose clamp. See Figure 4. This nozzle tip will be connected to the nozzle body left installed in the distribution piping. c. In the pail cover, drill the number of holes required, large enough to insert 1/2 in. NPT fittings, with one addi- tional hole that can be used for venting. d. Secure 1/2 in. compression fitting/threaded adaptors to the pail cover, using 1/2 in. conduit nuts. See Figure 4. 1N NOZZLE TIP AND RETAINER RIB ON NOZZLE (PART NO. 56930) 1/2 IN. TUBING-+ muff 1/2 IN. ADJUSTABLE HOSE CLAMP TUBING 1/2 IN. COMPRESSION INSERT - /FITTING/THREADED ADAPTOR 1/2 IN. f/ CONDUIT NUTS PAIL COVER FIGURE 4 e. Attach the tubing ends to the compression fittings. Tubing inserts will be required. See Figure 4. f. Install nozzle/tubing ends to nozzle bodies in discharge piping. g. Make certain each length of tubing is fastened to the pail cover with the cover snapped securely to the pail. 9. Complete the following steps in the flushing procedure: a. Connect discharge hose, from the flushing tank, to the distribution piping at the tank union. L7 Before attempting any further procedures, the nitrogen cylinder assembly and flushing agent tank must be secured to an immovable object to prevent an accident due to hazardous cylinder and/or tank movement. Secure both the nitrogen cylinder and discharge tank. c. Make certain that the nitrogen cylinder valve and the ball valve is CLOSED. d. Verify that all hose and/or tubing is securely fastened. e. With the regulator set at 100 PSI (690 kPa), open the nitrogen cylinder valve. f. Open ball valve to pressurize and discharge the solu- tion in the tank. g. After all nozzles have stopped discharging liquid, allow nitrogen gas to flow for a minimum of 15 seconds, then close ball valve. h. Close nitrogen cylinder valve. i. Relieve pressure between ball valve and cylinder valve by opening ball valve. j. After all pressure has been relieved from piping, dis- connect all hoses and tubing/plastic bags. k. Follow the same procedures for each additional tank piping to be flushed. I. Wash out all system nozzle tips and strainers in warm soapy water, rinse and return all tips and strainers to their appropriate locations in the discharge piping. m. Wash out nozzle tips used for blowdown and rinse out tubing and hose. 10. Fill each tank with 1.5 (5.8 L) or 3.0 gallons (11.6 L) of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. Make certain tank is filled to 1 in. t 1/8 in. (2.54 cm t 3 cm). DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in agent entering gas hose and regulator potentially causing system malfunction. 11. Replace bursting disc, Part No. 416974, in adaptor assembly. Make certain silver side of disc is away from tank. 12. Replace adaptor/tube assembly and tighten into place. Return and secure each tank in regulated release assembly and mounting bracket/enclosure. Reconnect expellant gas and distribution piping as required. 13. Raise tension lever to "UP" position. 14. Cock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever Part No. 14995) and install lock bar (Part No. 14985). SECTION VII - RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 7-3 1 RECHARGE (Continued) 15. Remove empty cartridge from regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly -as required. CAUTION Do not install replacement cartridge at this time or system may be actuated. 16. Install properly -rated fusible links in all detectors except the terminal detector. NOTICE If actuation was caused by a fire situation, all fusible links must be replaced. 17. Install test link (Part No. 15751) in terminal detector. 18. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. 19. Remove the lock bar. 20. Using wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detector to simulate automatic actuation. NOTICE If regulated release mechanism does not actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of the "Testing Detection System" portion of the "Testing and Placing In Service" section, Page 6-4, of this manual. 21. After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP" position. 22. Install properly -rated, Ansul approved, fusible link in terminal detector. 23. Cock the regulated release mechanism and install lock bar Part No. 14985). 24. Locate detector linkage and correctly position in each bracket. 25. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. 26. Inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make certain there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clearance between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. NOTICE If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever to "UP" position, raise trip hammer 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm), tighten set screws, and repeat Steps 25 and 26. 27. Remove lock bar. 28. Manually test the regulated release mechanism by operating the remote manual pull station. 29. Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert the lock bar. 30. Reset all devices which were affected by the system actu- ation. Refer to "Resetting" section, Page 7-3 and 7-4. RESETTING Resetting Remote Manual Pull Station Metal Stamped Style Reset each remote manual pull station by completing the fol- lowing steps: 1. If necessary, remove set screw that is retaining the break glass rod. 2. If necessary, carefully remove any remaining broken glass from station. 3. Press and position ring handle in proper location against cover and slide the replacement glass break rod (Part No. 4834) through stud and handle. 4. Tighten set screw into stud. 5. If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace- ment," Page 7-4, and complete steps 1 through 5. Molded Plastic Style 1. Position pull ring in vertical groove of pull station cover. 2. Insert break -away seal, Part No. 79029, through holes in cover and snap in place. Resetting Mechanical Gas Shut -Off Valve Reset each mechanical gas shut-off valve by completing the fol- lowing steps: To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical or mechan- ical devices that are capable of igniting gas. 1. Remove side cover from gas valve housing. 2. Extend air cylinder rod to full "UP" position. Air cylinder is located inside the regulated release assembly enclosure. 3. Recock gas valve by pulling valve stem up so pin in stem engages in cocking lever. 4. Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR EXISTS, MANUALLY PUSH THE AIR CYLINDER ROD TO THE FULL "DOWN" POSITION IMMEDIATELY. This will cause the mechanical gas valve to shut the gas line off. Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding any further. 5. If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this time. 6. Reinstall side cover to gas valve housing. On Ansul type valve, make certain roll pin is positioned within both sides of the valve housing slot and secure visual inspection seal Part No. 197). 7. If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace- ment," Page 7-4, and complete steps 1 through 5. SECTION VII — RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 7-4 REV. 1 RESETTING (Continued) Resetting Electrical Switch (Snap -Action) Reset the electric (snap -action) switch by completing the fol lowing steps: 1. Make certain the power source is on. Electric (snap -action) switch is reset automatically when the regulated release mechanism is recocked. If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace- ment," Page 7-5, and complete steps 1 through 5. Resetting Electrical Gas Shut -Off Valve Reset each electric gas shut-off valve by completing the following steps: CAUTION To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical or mechan- ical devices that are capable of igniting gas. 1. Make certain the power source is on. 2. Depress reset button on manual reset relay (red light on). Gas valve will resume its normal operating (open) position. 3. Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR EXISTS, TURN OFF POWER SOURCE IMMEDIATELY. This will cause the electric gas valve to shut the gas line off. Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding any further. 4. If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this time. 5. If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace- ment," Page 7-5, and complete steps 1 through 5. Resetting Pressure Switch Reset the pressure switch by completing the following: 1. Depress the reset button(s) on the pressure switch cover. The pressure switch assembly(ies) is located on the right side of the regulated release enclosure. An audible click will be heard to verify the pressure switch has resumed its normal (non -actuated) condition. 2. If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace- ment," Page 7-5, and complete steps 1 through 5. REPLACEMENT CARTRIDGE To complete the recharge and resetting procedures: 1. Remove shipping cap and weigh replacement cartrdige. Replace if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below weight stamped on cartridge. 2. Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and lock bar is installed. Then, install replacement cartridge into the regulated release assembly and each regulated actu- ator receiver and hand tighten. 3. Remove lock bar. 4. Snap cover on regulated release and each regulated actu- ator assembly, insert visual seal (Part No. 197) in upper and lower cover hole and secure. 5. Record recharge date on tag attached to unit and/or in a permanent file. SECTION Vill — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 8-1 REV. 1 C C Maintenance is required semi-annually. At the 12 year interval, along with the normal maintenance exam, the tank(s) must be hydro -tested and the regulator(s) must be flow tested. SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION Semi-annual maintenance procedures for single, double, and multiple -tank systems are as follows. NOTICE Under certain circumstances hood and duct cleaning operations may render the fire sup- pression system ineffective due to a coating of cleaning chemical left on the detection equipment or mishandling of the system by cleaning service personnel. Therefore, it is strongly recommended that the R-102 system be completely inspected and serv- iced by an authorized Ansul distributor immediately following any such cleaning operations. Remove the enclosure cover from the ANSUL AUTOMAN regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly. Insert the lock bar (Part No. 14985) on the cocked regulated release mechanism. See Figure 1. 7. From tank in enclosure: Remove tank. Keep in upright posi- tion to avoid spilling the agent. From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage bracket band, and remove each tank. Keep tank in upright position to avoid spilling the agent. 8. Remove tank adaptor/tube assembly from each tank. See Figure 2. FIGURE 2 9. Make certain that each tank is filled to a level of 1 in. t 1/8 (2.54 cm t .3) from the bottom of the fill opening. See Figure 3. D. CAUTION CK BAR OPERLY Make certain tank is filled to 1 in. f 1/8 in. (2.54 cm f TnLLEo 3 cm). DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in agent entering gas hose and regulator potentially causing system malfunction. FIGURE 1 3. Remove cartridge from regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly, install safety shipping cap, and set aside in a safe location. 4. Remove gasket from cartridge receiver in regulated release mechanism and each regulated actuator. Check gasket for elasticity or cuts and replace if necessary. Clean and coat gasket lightly with a good grade of extreme temperature grease. Reinstall gasket into cartridge receiver(s). 5. From tank in regulated release assembly: Disconnect the expellant gas hose from each tank adaptor assembly. From tank in bracket/enclosure assembly: Disconnect the expellant gas piping union at each tank adaptor inlet line. 6. Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor outlet line. 1 IN. * 1/8 2.54 cm + .3 cm) FIGURE 3 SECTION Vill — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 8-2 SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) 10. Examine threads on each tank adaptor and tank collar for nicks, burrs, or cross -threading. Clean and coat O-ring with a good grade of extreme temperature grease. Make cer- tain bursting disc is in place and silver side is away from tank. Clean seating surface and return adaptor/tube assembly to each tank. Tighten securely. See Figure 4. FIGURE 4 11. Place fully charged tanks in enclosures and/or brackets and secure. 12. Carefully assemble and wrench tighten all expellant gas and agent distribution piping. 13. Remove blow -off caps from nozzles. Inspect each blow -off cap and replace if deteriorated. On metal blow -off caps, make certain spring clip rotates freely on cap. NOTICE Rubber blow -off caps that have been installed in the system for one year or more must be replaced. 14. Check all nozzles to ensure that they are free of cooking grease build-up and have a covering of clean silicone grease on the orifice. Reinstall blow -off caps. 15. Remove the lock bar and manually test the regulated release assembly by operating the remote manual pull sta- tion. Check pull station cover for damage or wear. Replace cover if cable has worn a groove in the cover as deep as the diameter of the cable. 16. Cock the regulated release mechanism using cocking lever Part No. 14995). See Figure 5. Before proceeding with Step 18, test electric (snap -action) switches: a. With the ANSUL AUTOMAN in the cocked or ready position, press the lever of each switch up. If the switch is working properly, there should be an audible click. b . With the ANSUL AUTOMAN in the fired position, press the lever of each switch up, there should be no audible click. c . If an audible click is heard in the fired position several adjustments can be made. The trip lever extension pin can be rotated so the peak of one of the hex points is pointed up against the switch levers. Tighten it in that position. If this doesn't resolve the problem, loosen the screws holding the switches, apply a small counter- clockwise torque on the switches and retighten the screws. If necessary, a final adjustment can be made by removing the snap action switch and bending the lever slightly. d . After adjustments, repeat Steps a. and b. Then, recock ANSUL AUTOMAN and insert lock bar. FIGURE 5 17. Raise tension lever to "UP" position. See Figure 6. TENSION LEVER IN "UP" POSITION FIGURE 6 SECTION VIII — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 8-3 C SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) 18. Install test link (Part No. 15751) in terminal detector. 19. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. See Figure 7. TENSION LEVER IN "DOWN" POSITION I GL 00 I If I If I , FIGURE 7 20. Using wire cutter, cut test link at terminal detector to simu- late automatic actuation. NOTICE If regulated release mechanism does not actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of "Testing Detection System" in "Testing and Placing in Service," Section 6, Page 6-3. 21. After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP" position. 22. Clean and return properly -rated, Ansul approved, fusible link to terminal detector. NOTICE Fusible links installed in system for one year or more must be replaced. Ansul recommends replacement of links every six months. 23. Remove, clean, and return additional fusible links to series detector linkage(s). (Fusible links loaded with grease and other extraneous material can result in excessive delays in actuation.) 24. Lower the tension lever to "DOWN" position. 25. Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert the lock bar. 26. Inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clear- ance between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. See Figure 8. 4 IN. (6.4 MM) AINIMUM TRIP HAMMER BASE FIGURE 8 NOTICE If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever to "UP" position, raise trip hammer 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm), tighten set screws, and repeat Steps 24 and 26. 27. Locate detector linkage and properly position in each bracket. For 'blip on" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket slightly toward termination end of detection run. For "scissor' style linkage, locate linkage in bracket all the way toward termination end of detection run. 28. Before reinstalling cartridge, reset all additional equipment by referring to appropriate section of "Recharge and Reset- ting Procedures," Section 7. 29. Remove shipping cap and weigh each cartridge. Replace if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below weight stamped on cartridge. 30. Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and lock bar is installed, then screw replacement cartridge into regulated release mechanism and each regulated actuator receiver(s) and hand tighten. 31. Remove lock bar. 32. Snap cover on regulated release and each regulated actu- ator, insert visual seal (Part No. 197) through holes in cover and box, and secure. 33. Record semi-annual maintenance date on tag attached to unit and/or in a permanent file. SECTION VIII — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 8-4 REV. 1 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION Twelve-year maintenance procedures for single, double, and multiple -tank systems are as follows. NOTICE Under certain circumstances hood and duct cleaning operations may render your fire sup- pression system ineffective due to a coating of cleaning chemical left on the detection equipment or mishandling of the system by cleaning service personnel. Therefore, it is strongly recommended that the R-102 system be completely inspected and serviced by an authorized Ansul dis- tributor immediately following any such cleaning operations. At twelve-year intervals, the liquid agent tank(s) must be hydrostatically tested and refilled with a fresh charge of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. The date of manufacture is stamped on the bottom of the agent tank. 1. Remove the enclosure cover from the ANSUL AUTOMAN regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly. 2. Insert the lock bar (Part No. 14985) on the cocked regulated release mechanism. See Figure 9. llift. BAR ERLY INSTALLED FIGURE 9 3. Remove cartridge from regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator assembly, install safety shipping cap, and set aside in a safe location. CAUTION Do not reinstall cartridge at this time or system may be actuated. 4. Remove gasket from cartridge receiver in regulated release mechanism and each regulated actuator. Check gasket for elasticity or cuts and replace if necessary. Clean and coat gasket lightly with a good grade of extreme temperature grease. Reinstall gasket into cartridge receiver(s). 5. From tank in enclosure: Disconnect the expellant gas hose from each tank adaptor assembly. From tank in bracket assembly: Disconnect expellant gas piping union at each tank adaptor inlet line. 6. Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor outlet line. 7. From tank in enclosure: Remove tank. From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage bracket band, and remove each tank. Keep tank in upright position to avoid spilling the agent. 8. Loosen tank adaptor/tube assembly and remove. 9. Safety glasses should be worn during transfer operations of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. Avoid contact with skin or eyes. In case of contact, flush immediately with water for 15 minutes. If irritation per-. sists, contact a physician. Do not take internally. If taken internally do not induce vomiting. Dilute with water or milk and contact a physician. Pour the liquid agent from the tank into a clean, plastic con- tainer, and flush tank with clear water. 10. At this point, each liquid agent tank, including the 1/4 in. gas hose assembly, must be HYDROSTATICALLY TESTED to 300 psi (2069 kPa). Verify date stamped on cartridge. The cartridge must be hydrotested at intervals not greater than 12 years. If cartridge date indicates the need for hydrotesting, the cartridge must be bled down through normal ANSUL AUTOMAN release operation, returned to Ansul for credit, and replaced with a charged, replacement cartridge. J NOTICE Cartridge bleed down can be used to verify pneumatic accessories operation. 11. The regulator must be flow tested at 12 year intervals. Check the date code stamped on the regulator body to determine if the regulator(s) requires the 12 year testing (see data code table). If regulator does not require testing, proceed to step 12. Flow test the regulator(s) per the following: Date Code Table Month — Code Year — Code January A 1986 R February B 1987 S March C 1988 T April D 1989 U May E 1990 V June F 1991 W July G 1992 Y August H 1993 Z September J 1994 A October K 1995 B November L 1996 C December M 1997 D 1998 E 1999 F 2000 G Ql SECTION Vill — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 8-5 C 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) 11. (Continued) a. Regulated Release Mechanism For First Tank: Disconnect expellant gas hose from tank. Connect regulator test kit (Part No. 56972) to hose. See Figure 10. FIGURE 10 For Second Tank: Disconnect expellant gas piping at union. Remove union from expellant gas piping and install pipe cap to prevent cartridge pressure from escaping during test. See Figure 11. E FIGURE 11 Pressure Switch: If pressure switch is provided, it should remain connected as part of system mainte- nance test. NOTICE For multiple -tank systems, one test kit (Part No. 56972) is required for each regulator in the system. b. Regulated Actuator For First Tank: Disconnect expellant gas hose from tank. Connect regulator test kit (Part No. 56972) to hose. See Figure 12. FIGURE 12 For Second Tank: Disconnect expellant gas piping at union. Remove union from expellant gas piping and install pipe cap to prevent cartridge pressure from escaping during test. See Figure 13. FIGURE 13 NOTICE Make certain valve is closed on regulator test kit or pressure will escape before test can be performed. c. Install LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge(s) (Part No. 5373) into release mechanism and each regulated actuator provided with the system. (Cartridge should be condi- tioned to approximately 70 OF (21 °C) before test.) SECTION Vlll — MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 8-6 REV. 1 i 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) d. Remove lock bar and operate remote manual pull sta- tion to actuate the regulated release and supply pres- sure to each test kit. e. Flow test each regulator by completing the following steps: Open test kit valve fully and check gauge while pressure is bleeding off. Gauge reading should stabilize between 95-125 psi (655-862 kPa) during the first 10 seconds of flow. Pressure will fall off as the cartridge is exhausted of nitrogen. Allow cartridge pressure to completely bleed off. If necessary, continue flow test at each additional regulated actuator. Test each regulated actuator by repeating step e. f. Cock release mechanism using cocking lever (Part No. 14995) and insert lock bar (Part No. 14985). g. Remove empty nitrogen cartridge(s) from release mech- anism and each regulated actuator. h. Remove test kit(s) from release mechanism and each regulated actuator. i. If regulator test was not successful, replace regulator. j. Reconnect all expellant gas lines. k. Reset all additional equipment that was operated by release mechanism. 12. Examine threads on each adaptor and tank collar for nicks, burrs, or cross -threading. Clean and coat O-ring with a good grade of extreme temperature grease. Make certain bursting disc is in place and silver side is away from tank. See Figure 14. FIGURE 14 13. Refill each tank with 1.5 gallons (5.8 L) or 3.0 gallons 11.6 L) of new ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. When filled, level of liquid should be 1 in. t 1/8 (2.54 cm t .3) from bottom of fill opening. See Figure 15. Make certain tank is filled to 1 in. t 1/8 in. (2.54 cm t 3 cm). DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in agent entering gas hose and regulator potentially causing system malfunction. 1 IN. * 1/8 2.54 cm * .3 cm) FIGURE 15 14. Clean seating surface and return each adaptor/tube assembly to tank. Firmly tighten. NOTICE Do not reinstall any tank at this time. 15. Remove blow -off caps from nozzles. Inspect each blow -off cap and replace if deteriorated. On metal blow -off caps, make certain spring clip rotates freely on cap. NOTICE Rubber blow -off caps that have been installed in the system for one year or more must be replaced. 16. Check all nozzles to ensure that they are free of cooking grease build-up and have a covering of clean silicone grease on the orifice. Reinstall blow -off caps. 17. Remove lock bar and manually test the regulated release assembly by operating the remote manual pull station. 18. Cock the regulated release mechanism using cocking lever Part No. 14995). See Figure 16. FIGURE 16 SECTION VIII - MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 8-7 C 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) 19. Raise the tension lever to "UP" position. See Figure 17 C TENSION LEVER IN "UP" POSITION FIGURE 17 20. Install test link (Part No.15751) in terminal detector. 21. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. See Figure 18. 11 TENSION LEVER IN "DOWN" POSITION FIGURE 18 22. Using wire cutter, cut test link at terminal detector to simu- late automatic actuation. NOTICE If regulated release mechanism does not actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of "Testing Detection System" in "Testing and Placing in Service," Section 6. 23. After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP" position. 24. Clean and return properly -rated, Ansul approved, fusible link to terminal detector. NOTICE Fusible links installed in system for one year or more must be replaced. 25. Remove, clean, and return additional fusible links to series detector linkage(s). (Fusible links loaded with grease and other extraneous material can result in excessive delays in actuation.) 26. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. 27. Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert lock bar. 28. Inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) clear- ance between the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly. See Figure 19. 114 IN. (6.4 MM) MINIMUM TRIP HAMMER BASE FIGURE 19 NOTICE If clearance is not 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum, raise tension lever to "UP" position, raise trip hammer 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm), tighten set screws, and repeat Steps 26 and 28. 29. Locate detector linkage and properly position in each bracket. 30. Make certain additional devices have operated as intended. 31. Before reinstalling cartridge, reset all additional equipment by referring to appropriate section of "Recharge and Reset- ting Procedures," Section 7. 32. Place each fully charged tank in enclosure and/or bracket and secure. 33. Reconnect all distribution piping and expellant gas piping unions as required. Wrench tighten. 34. Check each gas cartridge by removing shipping cap and weighing cartridge. Replace if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below weight stamped on cartridge. 35. Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and lock bar is installed, then screw replacement cartridge into regulated release mechanism and each regulated actuator receiver(s) and hand tighten. 36. Remove lock bar. 37. Place regulated release assembly and each regulated actu- ator assembly enclosure cover in -place. 38. Insert visual seal (Part No. 197) in holes in cover and box and secure. 39. Record date of 12 year maintenance examination on tag attached to enclosure and/or in a permanent file. K1 ro SECTION IX - APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-1 REV. 1 SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE Total Tank Type of Nitrogen Flow No.' Ouantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required 1-5 1 Single 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release LT-20-R (7032) 6-11 1 Single 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release LT-30-R (5373) 12-16 2 Double 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 17-22 2 Double 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 23-27 3 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release LT-20-R (7032) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 28-33 3 Multiple 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release LT-30-R (5373) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 34-38 4 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator ' LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 39-44 4 Multiple 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 45-49 5 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release LT-20-R (7032) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 50-55 5 Multiple 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release LT-30-R (5373) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 56-60 6 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 61-66 6 Multiple 3.0 Gal. Reg. Release Double (73022) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 67-71 7 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 1.5 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101.30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-30-R (5373) Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3.0 gal. system. See pages 4.30 and 4.33 for exceptions. II tanks are manifolded. only a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Pan No. 73022) can be used. II tanks are manifolded. only an LT-A-101.30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 29187) can be used. Carbon Dioxide Cartridge Required 101-10 (15850) 101-20 (17492) 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)" 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-20 (17492) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)- 101-30 (15851). 101-10(15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-20 (17492) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)- 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-20 (17492)"' SECTION IX - APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-2 REV. 1 SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE (Continued) Total Tank Type of Nitrogen Flow No.' Quantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required 72-77 7 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-30-R (5373) 78-82 8 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 1.5 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 83-88 8 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (28187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 89-93 9 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 1.5 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-20-R (7032) 01 94-99 9 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-30-R (5373) 100-104 10 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 1.5 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3.0 gal. system. See pages 4.30 and 4.33 for exceptions. If tanks are manifolded, only a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 73022) can be used. If tanks are manifolded, only an LT-A-101.30 nitrogen cartridge Part No. 29187) can be used. Carbon Dioxide Cartridge Required 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-20 (17492) 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851) " 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-20 (17492) 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101 -20(17492) 101-10 (15850) 101-30 (15851) 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' 101-30 (15851)"' SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-3 REV. 1 C SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE (Continued) Total Tank Type of Nitrogen Carbon Dioxide Flow No. Quantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required Cartridge Required 105-110 10 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (15850) 101-10 (15850) 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 101-30 (15851)"' 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 101-30 (15851)"' 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (28187) 101-30 (15851)"' 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (28187) 101-30 (15851)"' 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank 3.0 Gal. Reg. Actuator LT-A-101-30 (29187) 101-30 (15851)"' 3.0 Gal. Additional Tank Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gat. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3.0 gal. system. See pages 4.30 and 4-33 for exceptions. It tanks are manifolded, only a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Pan No. 73022) can be used. If tanks are manifolded, only an LT-A-101.30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 29187) can be used. SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-4 REV. 1 SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX Part No. Description 78937 3.0 Gallon Red Painted Tank -Bracket Shipping Assembly Includes: Red Painted Tank Red Painted Bracket Adaptor/Tube Assembly 79290 3.0 Gallon Mechanical ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Shipping Assembly Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism in Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure Red Painted Tank Adaptor/Tube Assembly 79292 3.0 Gallon Electric ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Shipping Assembly Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism with Solenoid and Switch in Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure Red Painted Tank Adaptor/Tube Assembly 79327 3.0 Gallon Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly Includes: Actuator and Regulator in Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure Red Painted Tank Adaptor/Tube Assembly 78929 3.0 Gallon Tank and Stainless Steel Mounting Box Shipping Assembly Includes: Red Painted Tank Stainless Steel Mounting Box Adaptor/Tube Assembly 78232 1.5 Gallon Tank -Bracket Shipping Assembly Includes: Red Painted Tank Red Painted Bracket Adaptor/Tube Assembly 79291 1.5 Gallon Mechanical ANSUL AUTOMAN Regulated Release Shipping Assembly Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism in Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure Red Painted Tank Adaptor/Tube Assembly 79137 1.5 Gallon Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly Includes: Actuator and Regulator in Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure Red Painted Tank Adaptor/Tube Assembly 78921 1.5 Gallon Tank and Stainless Steel Mounting Box Shipping Assembly Includes: Red Painted Tank Stainless Steel Mounting Box Adaptor/Tube Assembly 56972 Regulator Test Kit Includes: Gauge, Hose and Valve Assembly Part No. Description 79694 1.5 Gallon (5.8 L) Container of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 79372 3.0 Gallon (11.6 L) Container of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 7032 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-20-R) 5373 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-30-R) 73022 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (R-102 Double -Tank) 29187 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-A-101-30) 15850 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-10) 17492 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-20) 15851 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-30) 56932 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1 W) Includes: 25 1 W Nozzles (Part No. 56927) 25 Blow -Off Caps 56934 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1/2N) Includes: 2 1/2N Nozzles (Part No. 56929) 2 Blow -Off Caps 56935 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1N) i Includes: 25 IN Nozzles (Part No. 56930) 25 Blow -Off Caps 76781 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (3N) Includes: 2 3N Nozzles (Part No. 76782) 2 Blow -Off Caps 73830 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (2WH) Includes: 25 2WH Nozzles (Part No. 78078) 25 Blow -Off Caps 415570 Swivel Nozzle Shipping Assembly (INS) Includes: 9 INS Nozzle (Part No. 415566) 9 Blow -Off Caps 415571 Swivel Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1 WS) Includes: 9 1 WS Nozzles (Part No. 415567) 9 Blow -Off Caps 56933 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (2W) Includes: 25 2W Nozzles (Part No. 56928) 25 Blow -Off Caps 418128 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (230) Includes: 25 230 Nozzles (Part No. 418117) 25 Blow -Off Caps 418129 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (245) Includes: 25 245 Nozzles (Part No. 418118) 25 Blow -Off Caps I c SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued) Part No. Description 418130 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (260) Includes: 25 260 Nozzles (Part No. 418119p 25 Blow -Off Caps 418131 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (290) Includes: 25 290 Nozzles (Part No. 418120 25 Blow -Off Caps 418132 Nozzle Shipping Assembly Includes: 2 2120 Nozzles (Part No. 418121) 2 Blow -Off Caps 77695 Blow -Off Cap Shipping Assembly (Spare) Includes: 50 Blow -Off Caps 79745 Metal Blow -Off Cap Shipping Assembly Includes: 10 Blow -Off Caps For Standard Non -Swivel Nozzles 415568 Metal Blow -Off Cap Shipping Assembly Includes: 10 Blow -Off Caps for Swivel Nozzles 56837 Series Detector Package ("Clip -On") 56838 Terminal Detector Package ("Clip -On") Includes: Test Link 15373 Series Detector Package ("Hinged") 15375 Terminal Detector Package ("Hinged") Includes: Test Link 417369 Series Detector Package ("Scissor") 417368 Terminal Detector Package ("Scissor") Includes: Test Link 415671 Pulley Elbows Shipping Assembly Socket End) — to 700 OF (371 °C) Includes: 50 Elbows (Part No. 415670) 73868 Pulley Elbows Shipping Assembly Compression End) — to 700 IF (371 °C) Includes: 50 Elbows (Part No. 45771) 15342 Pulley Tee 15821 Wire Rope (50 Feet (15 m)) 79653 Wire Rope (500 Feet (152 m)) 24919 Stop Sleeve Package Includes: 10 Stop Sleeves (Part No. 26317) 24918 Oval Sleeve Package Includes: 10 Oval Sleeves (Part No. 4596) SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-5 REV. 1 Part No. Description 78196 1/4 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" (Part No. 78195) 77285 3/8 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" (Part No. 77284) 77287 1/2 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" (Part No. 77286) 77289 3/4 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" (Part No. 77288) 79149 1/4 in. "Compression -Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Compression -Seals" (Part No. 79148) 79151 3/8 in. "Compression -Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Compression -Seals" (Part No. 79150) 79147 112 in. "Compression -Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Compression -Seals" (Part No. 79146) 79153 1/2 in. "Compression -Seal" EMT Conduit Adaptor Package Includes: 24 "Compression -Seals" (Part No. 79152) 79768 Hood Seal Adaptor Shipping Assembly Includes: 6 Hood Seals 13707 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Solenoid Valve — 3/4 in. 13708 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Solenoid Valve — 1 in. 13709 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Solenoid Valve — 1 1/2 in. 13710 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Fluid Power Gas Valve — 2 in. 17643 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Fluid Power Gas Valve — 3 in. 14702 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: Relay — Manual Reset SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-6 REV. 1 SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued) Part No. Description 15549 Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Single -Pole, Double Throw Includes: Electric Switch (SPDT) 32222 Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Double -Pole, Double Throw Includes: 2 Electric Switches (SPDT) 415868 Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Three -Pole, Double Throw Includes: 3 Electric Switches (SPDT) 32220 Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Four -Pole, Double Throw Includes: 4 Electric Switches (SPDT) 53133 Pressure Switch (SPDT) 24377 Pressure Switch (DPDT) 55598 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (Ansul) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 3/4 in. 55601 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (Ansul) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 1 in. 55604 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (Ansul) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 1 1/4 in. 55607 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (Ansul) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 1 1/2 in. 55610 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (Ansul) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 2 in. 25937 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ASCO) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 2 1/2 in. 25938 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ASCO) Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve — 3 in. 15733 Gas Shut-off Equipment Includes: Air Cylinder and Tube Assembly 4835 Remote Manual Pull Station — Metal Stamped Includes: Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly 50 Ft. (15 m) of Wire Rope 415255 Remote Pull Station — Plastic Molded 415256 Trim Ring (12) Includes: 25 Trim Rings, (Part No. 73859) For Plastic Molded Pull Station) 415317 Break -away Seal Shipping Assembly Includes: 25 Break -away seals, Part No. 79029 24915 Break Rod Package Includes: 10 Glass Break Rods (Part No. 4834) Replacement) Part No. Description 7032 Recharge Equipment Includes: LT-20-R Cartridge 5373 Recharge Equipment Includes: LT-30-R Cartridge 73022 Recharge Equipment Includes: Double System Cartridge 29187 Recharge Equipment Includes: LT-A-101-30 Cartridge 15850 Recharge Equipment Includes: 101-10 Cartridge 17492 Recharge Equipment Includes: 101-20 Cartridge 15851 Recharge Equipment Includes: 101-30 Cartridge 79372 Recharge Equipment Includes: 3.0 Gallon (11.4 L) Container of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 79674 Recharge Equipment Includes: 1.5 Gallon (5.7 L) Container of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant 417911 Recharge Equipment Includes: Package of 10 Tank Adaptor Bursting Discs 77695 Recharge Equipment Includes: 50 Blow -Off Caps 24916 Recharge Equipment Includes: 10 Test Links (Part No. 15751) 415739 Recharge Equipment Includes: Fusible Link 165 OF (74 °C) 415740 Recharge Equipment Includes: Fusible Link 212 OF (100 °C) 415744 Recharge Equipment Includes: 25 Fusible Links 280 OF (138 °C) Part No. 415741) 415745 Recharge Equipment Includes: 25 Fusible Links 360 of (182 °C) Part No. 415742) 415746 Recharge Equipment Includes: 25 Fusible Links 450 OF (232 °C) Part No. 415743) 73867 Recharge Equipment Includes: 25 Fusible Links 500 OF (260 °C) Part No. 56816) c SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued) Part No. Description 79651 Recharge Equipment Includes: Detector Bracket — "Clip -On" 53771 Recharge Equipment Includes: Detector Linkage — "Clip -On" 79651 Recharge Equipment Includes: Detector Bracket — "Scissor" 415817 Recharge Equipment Includes: Detector Linkage — "Scissor" 15344 Recharge Equipment Includes: Detector Bracket — "Hinged" 15343 Recharge1Equipment Includes: Detector Bracket Linkage — Hinged" 14985 Recharge Equipment Includes: Lock Bar 14995 Recharge Equipment Includes: Cocking Lever 15618 Recharge Equipment Includes: Cocking Lever and Lock Bar Assembly 15240 Recharge Equipment Includes: 500 OF (260 °C) Exhaust Duct Thermometer 197 Recharge Equipment Includes: Lead and Wire Seal 418087 Recharge Equipment Includes: Installation Manual SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-6.1 REV. 1 SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-6.2 NOTES: SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 9-7 ANSUL AUTOMAN" REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY 1e Figure No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 Description Regulated Release Shipping Assembly Mounting Box Basic Release w/Regulator Basic Release w/Solenoid, Switch, and Regulator Self -Tapping Screw Spacer Tension Spring Lever and Bracket Assembly Machine Screw Lockwasher Hex Nut Caution Label Gasket Expellant Gas Cartridge Assembly LT-20-R/101-10 LT-30-R/101-20 Double Tank/101-30 Safety Shipping Cap Tank Assembly Tank Adaptor Assembly Bursting Disc (Not Shown) O-Ring (Not Shown) Shell Nameplate Hose Assembly Enclosure Cover Nameplate Solenoid Assembly Electric Snap -Action Switch 1.5 Gallon Mechanical Part No. 79291 79293 79140 71342 76555 79094 79300 14973 7310 14732 57652 181 7032/15850 5373/17492 73022/15851 77251 79098 79101 56909 79100 73760 79007 79325 79295 20 3.0 Gallon Mechanical Part No. 79290 79293 79140 71342 76555 79094 79300 14973 7310 14732 57652 181 5373/17492 73022/ 15851 77251 79015 79020 56909 79016 73761 79007 79325 79296 21 3.0 Gallon Electrical Part No. 79292 79293 79288 71342 76555 79094 79300 14973 7310 14732 57652 181 5373/17492 73022/ 15851 77251 79015 79020 56909 79016 73761 79007 79325 79296 14988 17781 SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 9-8 REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY 14 Figure 1.5 Gallon 3.0 Gallon No. Description Part No. Part No. Regulated Actuator Assembly 79137 79327 1 Mounting Box 79293 79293 2 Pneumatic Actuator Assembly 79340 79340 3 Hex Jam Nut 67990 67990 4 Flat Washer 67991 67991 5 Lockwasher 69521 69521 6 Gasket 181 181 7 Expellant Gas Cartridge Assembly LT-20-R/101-10 7032/15850 LT-30-R/101-20 5373/17492 5373/17492 Double Tank/101-30 73022/15851 73022/15851 LT-A-101-30/101-30 29187/15851 29187/15851 8 Safety Shipping Cap 77251 77251 9 Nameplate 57652 57652 Tank Assembly 79098 79015 10 Tank Adaptor Assembly 79101 79020 Bursting Disc (Not Shown) O-Ring (Not Shown) 56909 56909 11 Shell Assembly 79100 79016 12 Nameplate 73760 73761 13 Hose Assembly 79007 79007 14 Enclosure Cover 79325 79325 15 Nameplate 79364 - 79329 OSURE ASSEMBLY 2 A e— I e 14 Figure No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 C Description Tank -Enclosure Shipping Assembly Tank Assembly Shell Tank Adaptor Assembly Bursting Disc (Not Shown) O-Ring Nameplate Enclosure Cover Nameplate Screw Speed' Nut SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 9-9 s 1.5 Gallon 3.0 Gallon Part No. Part No. 78921 78929 79098 79015 79100 79016 79101 79020 56909 56909 73760 73761 78405 78405 78406 78406 78922 78930 15362 15362 12042 12042 SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 11-1-94 Page 9-10 TANK -BRACKET ASSEMBLY 2` 9 8 Figure 1.5 Gallon 3.0 Gallon No. Description Part No. Part No. Tank -Bracket Shipping Assembly 78232 78937 Tank Assembly 79098 79015 1 Shell 79100 79016 2 Tank Adaptor Assembly 79101 79020 3 Bursting Disc (Not Shown) 4 O-Ring 56909 56909 5 Nameplate 73760 73761 6 Bracket Assembly 31937 12063 7 Grommet 14089 14089 8 Grommet 8688 8688 9 Wing Nut 12065 SECTION IX — APPENDIX UL EX. 3470 3-15-95 Page 9-11 REV. 1 WARRANTY AND LIMITS OF WARRANTY A. Ansul Products Except as indicated in B below, your R-102 System,. sup- plied by Ansul Incorporated ("Ansul") is warranted to you as the original purchaser for five years from the date of delivery against defects in workmanship and material as pur- chaser's sole and exclusive remedy, Ansul will replace or repair any component part which, in its opinion, is defec- tive and has not been tampered with or subjected to misuse, abuse or exposed to highly corrosive conditions. B. Purchased Products The following items, which are not manufactured but pur- chased by Ansul, are warranted against defects resulting from the manufacturer's fabrication, process or parts for one year from the date of purchase: fusible links, electric gas shut-off valves, manual reset relay, snap -action switch and solenoid, detectors, electric manual pull station, pressure relief valves, and regulators. Evaluation of each reportedly defective relay, valve, etc. returned to Ansul will be made by the original manufacturer or an agent thereof and its judgment shall be final. C. EXCEPT AS PROVIDED IN (A) AND (B), THERE ARE NO OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED INCLUDING THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR PARTICULAR PURPOSE MADE BY ANSUL CONCERNING THIS SYSTEM. ANSUL SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL, SPE- CIAL OR SIMILAR DAMAGES. For repairs, parts and service of the Ansul System, contact your local Ansul representative, or Ansul Incorporated, Marinette, Wisconsin 54143-2542; 800-TO-ANSUL 800-862-6875). If 1 ANSUL INCORPORATED ONE STANTON STREET MARINETTE, WI 54143-2542 715-735-7411 I FORM NO./ SECTION PART NO. l 3 PRE-ENGINEERED SYSTEMS — VEHICLE Product Group No. 6) (Continued) CHECKFIRE Detection and Actuation Systems (Continued) CHECKFIRE SC Electric Detection and Actuation System Parts List F-89170-1 CHECKFIRE Pneumatic Detection and Actuation System Parts List F-81168 CHECKFIRE Electric Detection and Actuation System Parts List F-81280 CHECKFIRE Electric Detection and Actuation System — Series II Parts List F-8757 CHECKFIRE MP System Installation, Recharge, Inspection and Maintenance Part No. 416267 Manual CHECKFIRE SC Electric Detection and Actuation System Installation, Part No. 79061-01 Recharge, Inspection and Maintenance Manual Spot Detector Installation Instructions Part No. 416765 CHECKFIRE Electric Detection and Actuation System — Series II Part No. 70699-01 Installation, Inspection and Maintenance Manual CHECKFIRE Pneumatic Detection and Actuation System Installation, Part No. 55391-01 Inspection and Maintenance Manual PRE-ENGINEERED SYSTEMS — RESTAURANT Product Group No. 4) R-101 Systems R-101 General Specifications Data Sheet F-75112-7 Ansul R-101-10, R-101-20, and R-101-30 Systems With Pneumatic Actuator F-7426-1 Parts List Ansul R-101-10, R-101-20, and R-101-30 Systems Parts List F-7427-3 Terminal Detector Assembly and Link and Shield Assembly Parts List F-6999 R-101 Certification, Installation and Inspection Form Part No. 24789-02 R-101 Installation Design Sheet Part No. 24790 Restaurant System Manual Supplement Part No. 77702 R-101 Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems Manual Supplement Part No. 70481 R-101-20 Fire Suppression System Installation, Recharge, Inspection and Part No. 17548-06 Maintenance Manual R-101-30 Fire Suppression System Installation, Operation, Recharge, Part No. 25734-05 Inspection and Maintenance Manual Accessory Installation Instructions (Applies to R-101-10, R-101-20 Part No. 24488-01 and R-101-30 Systems) 12/13/94 5 I FORM NO./ SECTION PART NO. PRE-ENGINEERED SYSTEMS — RESTAURANT Product Group No. 4) R-102 Systems Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems 2-color Brochure F-8879-3 Ansul R-102 MANU-SPEC Sheet F-90138 Ansul R-102 (Standard UL 300 Listed) Data Sheet F-9501 ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant Agent Data Sheet F-9140 Quik-Seal" Adaptor Data Sheet F-86173-1 Model R-102 Restaurant System Parts List F-8497 R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System Dimensions F-8598-1 R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System Regulator Test and F-87125 Replacement Instructions Owner's Guide — Restaurant Fire Suppression System Part No. 418127 Ansul R-102 (UL 300) Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge and Part No. 418087-01 Maintenance Manual Ansul R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems Design, Installation, Part No. 79973-04 Recharge, and Maintenance Manual DETECTION AND CONTROL Product Group No. 3) J AUTOPULSE IQ-301 Analog Addressable Control Unit Data Sheet F-94101 AUTOPULSE 442R Agent Releasing Control Unit Data Sheet F-94124 AUTOPULSE 442D Deluge/Preaction Control Unit Data Sheet F-94125 AUTOPULSE FOUR Control System Data Sheet F-93204 AUTOPULSE 1000 Control System Data Sheet F-8363-4 AUTOPULSE 2000 and 3000 (Version 2) Control Systems Data Sheet F-87136-1 AUTOPULSE 4000 Control System Data Sheet F-83160-2 Fiber Optic Flame Detection System for Fixed Paint Applications Brochure F-93223 IR-2LF Fiber Optic Flame Detectors and LFX Amplifiers Data Sheet F-9474 Electric Manual Pull Station Data Sheet F-8516-2 Auxiliary Switches Data Sheet F-87100 SLK-24F Photoelectric Smoke Detector Data Sheet F-8970-1 SIH-24F Ionization Smoke Detector Data Sheet F-90121 Alarm Horns Data Sheet F-82349-3 Strobe/Horn Data Sheet F-8430-2 Strobe Alarm Data Sheet F-8660 Alarm Bell Data Sheet F-82351-2 Thermal Detector (Rate Compensated) Data Sheet F-82352-4 4/21 /95 6 CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA APP-ICATION FOR BUILDING PERMIT PERMIT ADDRESS n(I/`} R i- C [ t PERMIT NUMBER Total Contract Price of Job Describe Work (N-A _ (4%1-1 Type of Construction Number of Stories Occupancy: Residential LEGAL DESCRIPTION TAX I.D. NUMBER OWNER ADDRE CITY TITLE HOLDER (IF OTHER THAN OWNER) ADDRESS n_. Number of Dwellings Commercial Total Sq. Ft. Flood Prone (YES) (NO) Zoning Industrial lease attach printout from Seminole County) CITY STATE BONDING COMPANY ADDRESS CITY STATE ARCHITECT ADDRESS CITY STATE MORTGAGE LENDER ADDRESS CITY STATE ZIP ZIP ZIP ZIP CONTRACTOR C o- ( 5ax/ 40 //VC PHONE NUMBER Ien ADDRESS [j 61, — ST. LICENSE NUMBER 5F7-3 17J CITY STATE ZIP7 5 Application is hereby made to obtain a permit to do the work and installations as indicated. I certify that no work or installation has commenced prior to the issuance of a permit and that all work will be performed to meet standards of all laws regulating construction in this jurisdiction. I understand that a separate permit must be secured for ELECTRICAL, PLUMBING, MECHANICAL, SIGNS, POOLS, ETC. OWNER'S AFFIDAVIT: I certify that all the foregoing information is accurate and that all work will be done in compliance with all applicable laws regulating construction and zoning. A COPY OF THE RECORDED COPY OF THE; NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT WILL BE POSTED ON THE JOB SITE WITH PERMITS NO LATER THAN SEVEN (7) DAYS AFTER THE PERMIT HAS BEEN ISSUED. FAILURE TO RECORD A NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT MAY RESULT IN YOU PAYING TWICE FOR THE IMPROVEMENTS TO YOUR PROPERTY. IF YOU INTEND TO OBTAIN FINANCING, CONSULT WITH YOUR LENDER OR AN ATTORNEY BEFORE RECORDING YOUR NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT. NOTICE: In addition to the requirements of this permit, there may be additional restrictions applicable to this property that may be found in the public records of this county, and there may be additional permits required from other governmental entities such as water management districts, state agencies, or federal agencies. ACCEPTANCE OF PERMIT IS VERIFICATION THAT I WILL NO OWNER OF THE PROPERTY OF THE REQUIREMENTS OF FLORIDA LIEN LAW, FS713. ro Z m o D A d O h Signature of Owner/Agent & Date Signature of Contractor & Date o w En Type or Print Owner/Agent Name Type or Print Contractor's Name v 3 m x a Z > 1 H VI •-•i c o 4 o o. O N T Z a E• Signature of. Notary & Date Signature of. Notary & Date Official Seal) (Official Seal) Application Approv BY: Date: L1 FEES: Building % R.dd Police Fire Open Space Road Impact Ap* E70G n L PERMIT VALIDATION: CHECK CASH DATEORIGINAL (BUILDING) YELLOW (CUSTOMER) PINK (COUNTY TAX OF LD (CO. ADMIN) 0 x ro n 0 a C n D a til THIS APPLICATION USED FOR WORK VALUED $2500.00 OR MORE CITY OF SANFORD. FLORIDA PERMIT NO. V1 DATE 1. k.3 — ``' THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOL- LOWING ELECTRICAL WORK: OWNER'S NAM 57M ADDRESS OF JOB 4-014Jn1 1 [ L ELEC. CONTR sC [ Cr iResi dential Non-residential Subject to rules and regulations of the city and national electric codes. Number AMOUNT Alteration, Addition Re air Change of Service Residential Commercial Mobile Home Factory Built Housing New Residential 0-100 Amp_ Service 101-200 Amp Service 201 Amp and a ova New Commercial Amp ervice IdOnlicationFee 1 i0n119Mf[t n) {-%3tC Ye ,PLC I V -U I By signing this application I am stating I will be in compliance with a NEC including Article 0. Section 110.9 and 110-10. i ding Official Master Electrician STATE COMPETENCY NO.5r_2Vf_ FROM i 1995.10-OS 11l42 #270 P.02/02 LETTER OF AUTHORIZATION THIS LETTER AUTHORIZES HEATH AND COMPANY, AS OUR LICENSED SIGN CONTRACTOR (OR THEIR AGENTS OR SUBCONTRACTORS) TO SECURE PERMITS AND/OR VARIANCES; TO PERFORM SIGN INSTALLATIONS, REMOVALS, OR ANY SIGN MAINTENANCE NECESSARY AT OUR PROPERTY. CUSTOMER NNE: AUTHORISED BY: STEAK 'N SHAKE SWORN TO AND SUBSCRIBED BEFORE ME THIS OCTOBER " a: J7 , 19 95 Bml 1 (LYN. HOTgBY _ NY COKKXSSION EXPIRES: 5TH DAY OF 9 10 98 RESIDENT OF MARION COUNTY HEATH AND COMPANY REPRESENTATIVE: PROPERTY LOCATION: 40 TOWN CENTER CIRCLE SEMINOLE TOWNE CENTER SANFORD, FL 32771 FROM a 1995l10-05 11s42 #270 P.02/02 LETTER OF AUTHORIZATION THIS LETTER AUTHORIZES HEATH AND COMPANY, AS OtM LICENSED SIGN CONTRACTOR (OR THEIR AGENTS OR SUBCONTRACTORS) TO SECURE PERMITS AND/OR VARIANCES; TO PERFORM SIGN INSTALLATIONS, REMOVALS, OR ANY SIGN MAINTENANCE NECESSARY AT OUR PROPERTY. I I CUSTOMER X MB: STEAK ' N SHAKE AUTHORI $BD BY z SWORN TO AND BQBSCRIBED MORE ME THIS OCTOBER , 19 95 aoTABY BVHLIC: MY CONKiSSION BXPZRBB: 9 10 98 RESIDENT OF MARION COUNTY BERTH AND COKPANY REPRESENTATIVE: PROPERTY LOCATION: 40 TOWN CENTER CIRCLE SEMINOLE TOWNE CENTER SANFORD, FL 32771 STH DAY OF CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA APPLICATION FOR BUILDING PERMIT 0 H PERMIT ADDRESS `ICJ Total Contract Price of Job JkgW4 S> N Describe Work PERMIT NUMBER (S _R I0J Total Sq. Ft. Type of Construction Flood Prone (YES) (NO) Number of Stories Number of Dwellings Zoning Occupancy: Residential Commercial Industrial LEGAL DESCRIPTION (please attach printou -om Seminole County) TAX I.D. NUMBER RSAM—F-32wo SM7.7" TITLE HOLDER (IF OTHER THAN OWNER) ADDRESS CITY BONDING COMPANY ADDRESS CITY ARCHITECT ADDRESS — CITY STATE 1i PHONE NUMBEP10 A. _. 7- 69%7J —00 STATE //V ` ZIP STATE STATE MORTGAGE LENDER ADDRESS CITY STATE ZIP ZIP ZIP ZIP CONTRACTOR .1A%L ,S/, 1 ( 0 {ur PHONE NUMBER G ( — I ADDRESS %'j )f7 Al. 01';5--t ST. LICENSE NUMBER G_T303 CITY Q,( STATE ZIP j7,,430¢ Application is hereby made to obtain a permit to do the work and installations as indicated. I certify that no work or installation has commenced prior to the issuance of a permit and that all work will be performed to meet standards of all laws regulating construction in this jurisdiction. I understand that a separate permit must be secured for ELECTRICAL, PLUMBING, MECHANICAL, SIGNS, POOLS, ETC. OWNER'S AFFIDAVIT: I certify that all the foregoing information is accurate and that all work will be done in compliance with all applicable laws regulating construction and zoning. A COPY OF THE RECORDED COPY OF THE NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT WILL BE POSTED ON THE JOB SITE WITH PERMITS NO LATER THAN SEV17N (7) DAYS AFTER THE PERMIT HAS BEEN ISSUED. FAILURE TO RECORD A NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT MAY RESULT IN YOU PAYING TWICE FOR THE IMPROVEMENTS TO YOUR PROPERTY. IF YOU INTEND TO OBTAIN FINANCING, CONSULT WITH YOUR LENDER OR AN ATTORNEY BEFORE RECORDING YOUR NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT. NOTICE: In addition to the requirements of this permit, there may be additional restrictions applicable to this property that may be found in the public records of this county, and there may be additional permits required from other governmental entities such as water management districts, state agencies, or federal agencies. ACCEPTANCE OF PERMIT IS VERIFICATION THAT I W , NOTIFY TH OWNER OF THE PROPERTY OF THE REQUIREMENTS OF FLORIDA LIEN LAW, FS713. i1r**************i***********tF**** it*rr****** #•* ** ****+k****#***rF*****tF**** H ro Z M O D m h n 0a O H Signature of Owner/Agent & Date Signature of Contractor & Date o a'< y 9G,FST Sd/ z E 4 o Z >. 1 H N rl b w i 0 0 O v >. Z o. E• Type or Print Owner/Agent Name Type or Print Contractor's Name o x Signature of Notary & Date :signature of Notary & Date Official Seal) (Official Seal) Application Approved BY: 29 Date: O FEES: Building 0 Radon Police ire Open Space Road mpact. Application PERMIT VALIDATION: CHECK CASH DATE 1.BY ORIGINAL (BUILDING) YELLOW (CUSTOMER) PINK (COUNTY TAX OFFICE) GOLD (CO. ADMIN) O x ro n 0 a c n K D Q. THIS APPLICATION USED FOR WORK VALUED $2500.00 OR MORE 3, I 2 I Tp c p r j I -To P e OT- II 1 r E LIE'\ rl O VZ SIGN NOTES 1. WIND LOAD IN ACCORDANC / S.B,.C. 9t ER100M.P.H. RFGION 2. 2000 P.S.F."MIN. SOIL B ING PRESSURE. 3. CONCRETE SHALL BE 3000 P. .I-. 0 28 DAYS. 4;. REINFORCING STEEL SHALL BE GRADE 60. 5. STRUCTURAL STEEL: fy-.36.K.S.I. G. SHOP DRAWINGS OF PRE-ENGINEERED SIGN FACE SIGNED AND SEALED BY A FLA. REGISTERED ENGINEER SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO RICHARDSON ENGINEERING FOR APPROVAL— PRIOR TO FABRICATION OR'ERECTION.* 7. TUBE *STEEL:" Fy = 466 K:S.I. . JOB NO: Is .1 TS PROJECT: %em- CLIENT: I Er=6',,5 F_ L. (:• R.ICHARDSON ENGINEERING 131 ZELMA STREET ORLANDO F.LOR1DA 32803 3.05 425-4602 GF LA APPLICATIONAPPLICATION ,FOR TEMPORARY CONSTRUCTIO - ACTIVITIES USE PERMIT CITY OF SANFORD, A. p Co DATE /d _/7- SS PERMIT NO. To the Building Official: The undersigned hereby ,applies for a permit for the following described work: OWNER S /P, i< ADDRESS yo l_ n .' P (- -11' NATURE OF WORK -/ LEGAL DESCRIPTION APPLICANT'S NAME UA APPLICANT'S ADDRESS ^ 1< ,-.,I-'/l APPLICANT'S PHONE NUMBER(-'ii3) G'- .Fe6 L FEE' Building Official 6/94) Application type = TCAU I certify that the above infor- mation is true and correct and that I will comply with all al)plic ble codes and ordinanc( of t City of Sa d, F 0 li n ' rIArDcaisnto e r'---'''---'--'---------`-------------- ---------------------'--- ------''' 0 NOVEMBER 1, 1995 CITY OF SANFORD BUILDING DEPARTMENT 300 NORTH PARK AVENUE SANFORD, FL 32771 SUBJECT: STEAK 'N SHAKE RESTAURANT - 40 TOWNE CENTER CIRCLE SANFORD, FL 32771 Dear Ladies & Gentlemen: A Consolidated Products Company Steak n Shake, Inc. TEMPORARY POWER 5980 West 71st Street Indianapolis, IN 46278 317) 388-4400 FAX (317) 387-6590 This letter will serve as our request for temporary power for testing purposes at the above subject project. We understand and agree that this energizing of the building will be used solely for testing and start-up of equipment. Under no circumstances will any personnel be using.or equipment be used to cook or produce any food products. We appreciate your assistance in this matter. If you have any questions, or need any additional information, please don't hesitate to contact me at the above location -on our letterhead. Sincerely, J. Andrew Burtner Construction Project Manager CITY OF S.ANFORD, FLORIDA APPLICATION FOR BUILDING PERMIT PERMIT ADDRESS .4D Total Contract Price _of ob Describe Work j Type of Construction Number of Stories Occupancy: Residential J PERMIT NUMBER Total Sq. Ft.A60 Flood Drone (YES) Number of Dwellings i Zoning _ Commercial _Jr Industrial NO LEGAL DESCRIPTION (please attach printout from Seminole County) TAX I.D. NUMBER C OWNER -"i Q N v L-P PHONE NUMBER ADDRESS CITY f.3-L, STATE ZIP XL ; TITLE HOLDER (IF OTHER THAN OWNER) ADDRESS CITY BONDING COMPANY ADDRESS CITY ARCHITECT ADDRESS _ CITY STATE STATE STATE ZIP ZIP ZIP MORTGAGE LENDER ADDRESS CITY STATE ZIP CONTRACTOR,, 'tv iYY7eJ (1{/UN` PHONE NUMBER`Ul'JO ADDRESS 6'10 -z- - 0 ST. LICENSE NUMBER CITY lam, STATE ZIP {r, Z' z wrr******,t,t,r*,r*rt****,:**rt**tr,t*rr*********isrt***w,t*rt***rr*****rt,r,r***,t,t*,t*w,*,r*,rrt,r***,t* Application is hereby made to obtain a permit to do the work and installations as indicated. I certify that no work or installation has commenced prior to the issuance of a permit and that all work will be performed to meet standards of all laws regulating construction in this jurisdiction. I understand that a separate permit must be secured for ELECTRICAL, PLUMBING, MECHANICAL, SIGNS, POOLS, ETC. OWNER'S AFFIDAVIT: I certify that all the foregoing information is accurate and that all work will be done in compliance with all applicable laws regulating construction and zoning. A COPY OF THE RECORDED COPY OF THE NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT WILL BE POSTED ON THE JOB SITE WITH PERMITS NO LATER THAN SEVEN (7) DAYS AFTER THE PERMIT HAS BEEN ISSUED. FAILURE TO RECORD A NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT MAY RESULT IN YOU PAYING TWICE FOR THE IMPROVEMENTS TO YOUR PROPERTY. IF YOU INTE:ND TO OBTAIN FINANCING, CONSULT WITH YOUR LENDER OR AN ATTORNEY BEFORE RECORDING YOUR NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT. NOTICE: In addition to the requirements of this permit, there may be additional restrictions applicable to this property that may be found in the public records of this county, and there may be additional permits required from other governmental entities such as water management districts, state agencies, or federal agencies. ACCEPTANCE OF PERMIT IS VERIFICATION THAT I THE REQUIREMENTS OF FLORIDA LIEN LAW, FS713 t****,r***,***rt**,ttr*w*rt**tr*trrt,t**rt*****rt*wrt 0 N v N J- U b 0 a x 0 c o. 3 0 E x UI -4 o w c o 0 0 ro ZwE• Si e gn t Owner/Agent & Date 19VI 7 - ei< yq% 0 ht Owner/Agent Name 61P + n Signature of Notary & Date Official Seal) L NOTIFY THE OWNER OF THE PROPERTY OF inrtr** w***********tr******r*wrt**** H 'V Z G M O 10 " r* M to G+ O f a u e of Contractor & Date 0 0 R C^rt::o 2 -T f iS ~ y H F Z or Pri t Contractor's Name v B O N Ta7(/ o ro lg +} c 1 Y rt NOTAR LIC, STATE OF FLORIDA My COMMISSION # CC476424 EXPIRES: June 26, 1999 Application Approved BY: Date: 4 FEES: Building Rad Police ire Open Space Rd9d Impact Application PERMIT VALIDATION: CHECK CASH DATE BY ORIGINAL (BUILDING) YELLOW (CUSTOMER) PINK (COUNTY TAX OFFICE) GOLD (CO. ADMIN) 0 O a C 0 r+ Ga lim THIS APPLICATION USED FOR WORK VALUED. $2500.00 OR MORE 99dr.nkb THOMAS SIGN & AWNING COI., INC. PLEASE EXECUTE CONTRACT AND RETURN WHITE COPY WITH DEPOSIT. THANK YOUI SALES AGREEMENT NO. 4841 This AGREEMENT made and entered into this 19th day of September 19 95, by and between Thomas Sign 8 Awning Company, Inc. Represented by D Sh i rah / P Taylor hereinafter called Seller, and Steak ' N Shake Andy Burtner 2990 West 71st St., Indianapolis, IN 46268 hereinafter called Buyer. Job Site: Steak 'N Shake Sanford, FL 317 388 4400 WITNESSETH: In oo isideration of convenants and agreements hereinafter contained, thu parties agree as follows: Seller will furnish, as per Sketch No. We will manufacture approximately 260' lineal feet of awning, 4' high with 4' projection. Framing is of rust free Structural Square tube aluminum heliarc welded. Material used will be 3M prescreened black and white stripe vinyl with Graphics Protection System. Lights by others. $22,932.00 Also manufactured and installed will be a Drive-thru" awning approximately 8'-6" x 8'- 8" x 4' projection. Material used will be 3M with GPS. Awning to have white graphics. 2832.00 Lighting by others. All bottoms will be eggcrate. Installation of the above described awnings. 5590.00 Electric by others. Permits to be billed at cost in addition to agreement price. TERMS: Nmt duo upon -p 1 of• i nn of runrk COST S 31,354.00 ruusc. DELIVERY i SUB TOTAL s 31,354.00 SALES TAX s 2,194.78 SUBTOTAL If 33, 548.78 DEPOSIT t AMOUNT DUE 33,548.78 CONDITIONS: It is further agreed by the parties hereto that the word "SIGN" as used below covers all signs and awnings Included in this contract whether one or more and that: 1. Buyer shall furnish Seller with complete address and plot plan showing exact locations of sign for each job. 2. Customer shall be responsible for adequate electric service to sign area and final electrloal hookup. 3. Since abnormal submerged conditions, such as rock, stumps, gas lines, electric lines, sewer lines, hard pen, water or send caveins, etc., cannot be foreseen, all hardship costs will be charged to the Buyer. 4. Seller reserves the right to modify or correct sign In any way necessary to conform with any changes in city, county, or state law regulations or orders and/or conditions beyond Seller's control at job site to Insure proper Installation. 5. Seller shall not be liable for any failure In performance resulting In labor troubles, fires, floods, windstorms, acts of God, war or other conditions or contingencies beyond Its control. 6. In the event location Is not In readiness for Installation when sign manufacture Is complete -90%of total contract shall be paid to Seller Immediately. 7. Permlt(s), if required, shall be billed at cost on final Invoice. 6. In the event of a breach of contract by the Buyer before erection of said sign, Buyer shall Immediately pay Seller for costs Incurred In labor and material to date. 9. ThIscontract shallapplytoand bind theheirs, executors, administrators. successors. and assigns ofBuyer,andshall inure tothe benefit of the Seller, his successors and assigns. 10. Electrical permit to be furnished by customers electrician. 11. INTEREST: Any payment amounts not paid when due shall accrue Interest at the highest legal rate of Interest allowed bylaw. 12. ATTORNEYS FEES AND COSTS: In any litigation arising out of this contract, the pre alling party shall be entitled to recover a reasonable attorney's fees and costs. DEALER ( SELLER) By n Rhirnh / P T+ylnr Sale. Representstive) Approved this +_-+* day of Scptcmbcr 19 9§ .at Clearwater, FL By Selby) Title CUSTOMER ( BUYER) Accepted by Buyrr This day of _ , 19 Company Nama By Buyer Title 4590 118TH Avenue North • Clearwater, FL. 34622 Pinellas ( 813) 573-7757 • Hillsborough (813) 932-4014 L E T T E R O F A U T H O R I Z A T I O N Date: SEPTEMBER 22, 1995 Customer: Steak'N Shake Address: 5980 W. 71st Street Indianapolis IN 46278 Phone #: Work Order #: Job Name: STEAK 'N SHAKE Address:. 40 TOWN CENTER CIRCLE SANFORD FL 32771 Phone #k : I/We hereby authorize Thonas Sign & Awning Company -Inc_., to pull permit/permits, and install sign/signs and/or awnings at the above referenced location. Customer Customer J. ANDREW BURTNER Construction Project Manager STEAK 'N SHAKE NOTARY AC NOWEEDQIENT STATE OF I ND I ANA COUN'i'Y OF MAR I ON Thy s is to Cer4.ify tliat on this 2 2ND day of SEPTEMBER , 199.5 , before me., the undersigned, a Notary Public in and for the State of INDIANAduly. arnnissioned and sworn, personally appeared ,J . ANDREW BURTNERknowntbmeandtomeknowntobetheperson/perso T and he/she they acknowledgedtomethathe/she/they executed the foregoing instrument freely and voluntarily. In witness hereof, I have hereunto set my hand and affixed by official seal, the day and year first written above. al , Public LYNDA L. REID) Resident of Marion County My CaRmission expires: 9 / 10 / 9 8 . 000t--c 00000000 o Certificate of Flame Resistance_ I \STC I REGISTERED FABRIC ISSUED BY Ell OR Date treated or CONCERN NUMBER monvfoctvred I n, •''O F-420.0 aEtr II This is to certify that the materials described on the reverse side hereof have been flame- retardent treated (or are inherently nonflammable). IIFORThomasThSign & Awning ADDRESS 10990 49th Street No. CITY Clearwater STATE FL 34622 I Certificationisherebymadethat: (Check "a" or "b") a) The articles described on the reverse side of this Certificate hove been treated with a flame-retardant I IchemicalapprovedandregisteredbtheStateFireMarshalandthattheapplicationofsaidchemicalnPP9YPPJ was done in conformance with the laws of the State of California and the Rules and Regulations of the State Fire Marshal. I INameofchemicalusedChem. Reg. No. IMethod of application I b) The articles described on the reverse side hereof are made from a flame -resistant fabric or material registered and approved by the State Fire Marshal for such use. PI & ITradenameofflame -resistant fabric or material used PANAF'LEX PII Reg. No. F-420.01 I The Flame Retardant Process Used Be Removed By Washing I IBy Frank L. Deyak Technical Service M r. I I Nameo/ Applicatof or Prodvction Svpefintendent Name /t Title FR-3 1 OOo ODOO[ OOO DO THIS REPRODUCIBLE ARTWORK IS FOR THE EXCLUSIVE USE OF STATE FIRE MARSHAL LICENSED CONCERNS AND INDIVIDUALS FOR THE PRODUCTION OF REQUIRED FORMS. CALIFORNIA STATE FIR)]' MARSHAL REGISTERED FLAME PRODUCT REGISTRATION N01. PRODUCT NAME: PANAFLEX SUBSTRATE PRODUCT MARKETED BY: RESISTANT F-420.01 ' 3 M COMMERCIAL GRAPHICS DIVISION 3 M Center, Bldg. 207-BW-09 St. Pail, MN 55144-1000 This product meets the minimum requirements of flame resistance established y the State Fire Marshal for products identified in. the California Health and Safety Code Section 13115. The scope of 'the approved use of this product is provided in the current edition of "California Approved List of Flame Retardant Chemicals and Fabrics, General and Limited Application Concerns." DUANE MATTH,k4S, Program Coordinator Laboratory/Chemicals/Fabrics CITY OF SAWMD, FLORIDA PERMIT NO. q5, 3 ` (P7 DATE q -C,-'? 9 -qk5 THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOLLOWING H.A.R.V. MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT: OWNER'S NAME -,tk - N-SAo L-e ADDRESS OF JOB 7O Coke G/P MECHANICAL CONTR. RESIDENTIAL COMMERCIAL /C Subject to rules and regulations of Sanford mechanical code. NATURE OF WORK r /7bo 03 FUEL MOTOR H.P. B.T.U. INPUT OUTPUT I II APPLICATION FEE TOTAL IL4 J Q r_ l COMPETENCY CARD NO. TROPIC-KOOL'kENGINEERING C4RP September 18, 1995 City of Sanford P.O. Box 1788 Sanford, FL 32772-1788 Dear Gentlemen: Please accept this Letter of Authorization for ROB STAUFFER to pull the Mechanical Permits for the STEAK N' SHAKE located at 40 TOWN CENTER CIRCLE, SANFORD, FL. ROB STAUFFER is a representative of Tropic-Kool Engineering Corp., and is authorized to pull this permit in my behalf. Your cooperation in this matter is greatly appreciated, and should you have any questions, please do not hesitate to contact me at (813) 581-2824, ext. 3024. Sinc ly, P (Phil) Ardis General Manager JPA/sh r STATE OF FLORIDA COUNTY OF PINELLAS SWORN TO AND SUBSCRIBED BEFORE ME THIS 18TH V lI.Q.,SEPTEMBER 1995. 1a 7 p Qt+ O *2T 1 0 .i,. •ice.• rNA i r NOT Y 60C 824.557 ' T 1232 Donogan Road Largo, Florida 34641 (813) 581.2824 Fax: (813) 587.7973 CA C051478 CM C053194 CITY OF SANFORD. FLORIDA PERMIT NO. 301 _ DATE ?- 13 — 95-- THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOL- LOWING ELECTRICAL WORK: OWNER'S NAME -5f4!5 ' & _5Wo S'EA•i vcLc= T w.v C Lsiv%t /.,sc-L ADDRESS OF JOB '/o 7"O"'V i Cy7L, C,CC, ELEC. CONTR_ F.eal Lc%C. F-5 _Residential__ Non-residential Subject to rules and regulations of the city and national electric codes. Number AMOUNT Alteration Addition, Repair Chance of Service Residential Commercial Mobile Home Factory Built housing New Residential 0-100 Amp_Service 101-200 Am Service 201 Amp an above New Commercial /po0 Amp Service 00 Application Fee 00 I i TOTAL By signing this application I am stating [will be in compliance with the NEC including Article 110. Section 110.9 and 110.10. Building Official Masfor E elrician STATE COMPETENCY NO. /.?900 CIt1141NFORD. FLORIDA PERMIT NO U— DATE / / / 9 THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOL- LOWING PLUMBING WORK: OWNER'S NAME S 74-6 // G — Al — S /Q ` - e ADDRESS OF JOB °1 0 % W ,, e Geri 6.- C L r c. PLUMBING CONTR T46 r to „^ I Res. _ Comm. Subject to rules and regulafions of Sanford plumbing code. Residential: I Number Amount Alteration, Addition, Repair New Residential: One Water Closet Additional Water Closet Commercial: Fixtures. Floor Drain, Trap 2 o Sewerr Water Piping Gas Piping Factory -built housing Mobile Home Application Fee Minimum Commercial Permit: $25. oo Total Master Plumber COMPETENCY CARD NO C F C 02 3 4 2 ' CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA PERMIT NO. "/ - / DATE l ZB (?S THE UNDERSIGNED HEREBY APPLIES FOR A PERMIT TO INSTALL THE FOLLOWING H.A.R.V. MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT: OWNER'S NAME T-G ADDRESS OF JOB 'C ItLAJ`J CAN ftC MECHANICAL CONTR.e-- T k: 407- 3G - C7 boo RESIDENTIAL COMMERCIAL Subject to rules and regulations of Sanford mechanical code. NATURE OF WORK FUEL MOTOR H.P B.T.U. INPUT OUTPUT -- VALUATION %CU, PY7["1-.c3 APPLICATION FEE I 11 /0 PO UMaster Mechanical COMPETENCY CARD NO. U ch,1-39 fTHARP Purveyors Of Fine Plumbing To Whom It May Concern: Please be advised that I, James W. Tharp, Jr. do hereby give W 0 I (cL Y• W V a, V 'Power of Attorney to pull0 the necessary permits for the Plumbing at Sid l e ,- S. ke in sa., Fee- d ^ Florida. Respectfully, TIiARP PLUMBING SYSTEMS, INC. J W. Tharp, Jr. . President STATE OF FLORIDA County of Orange L I, the undersigned authority, hereby certify that the fore- going is a true and correct copy of the instrument presented to me -by James W. Tharp, Jr. as the original of such instrutments. t Witness my hand and official seal, this t day of sQ,P c e-, NOTARY// PUOLIC My commission expires: 01ft& gyp MARCIELEWIS MY C MMisslon CC473463 Expires Jul. 09, 1999 y ce Bonded by HAI 800-422-1555 THARP PLUMBING SYSTEMS INC 625 WILMER AVE ORLANDO FL 32808 407-295.2370 FAX 407-293.2376 6 Lo l a c I vY s CITY 'OF SANFORD FIRE:DEPARTMENT FEES FOR SERVICES PHONE A An7-322-4952 TE : ?3/ PERMIT 41: - 9 SINESS N TyJ 75hR1'/_ DRESS: % i, L' cr, i o_r C' J l E NUMBER:( ) PLANS REVIEW . TENT PERMIT BURN PERMIT REINSPECTION TANK PERMIT FIRE SYSTEM AMOUNT $ - 2o?• 60 COMMENTS: C O,- 7 36 30 Sg L7- Fees must be paid to Sanford Building Department, 300 N. Park Avenue, Sanford, Florida. Phone # 330-5656. Proof of payment must be made to Sanford Fire Prevention bef re any furthe services can take place. Sanford Fire Prevention I certify that the above information is true and correct and that I will comply with all applicable code4and inances of the Cird, Florida. t- Applgnature CITY OF SANFORD FIRE:DEPARTMENT FEES FOR SERVICES PHONE #: 407-322-4952 DATE: PERMIT #: - BUSINESS NAME: ADDRESS: PHONE NUMBER:( PLANS REVIEW TENT PERMIT BURN PERMIT REINSPECTION TANK PERMIT FIRE SYSTEM AMOUNT $-2 COMMENTS: /n . S 42 zl X ,-e- i-%-7/1, P A %Dvn CohSTi Gio. Fees must be paid to Sanford Building Department, 300 N. Park Avenue, Sanford, Florida. Phone # 330-5656. Proof of payment must be made to Sanford Fire Prevention before any further services can take place. I certify that the above information is true and A correct and that I will comply with all applicable codes and ordinances of the City of Sanford, Florida. c Sanfor ' Fi P evention App cants Signature 09/30/95 10:22 a 002 Auquet 20, 199S ow -ow goon. E"cu" o•ec ta- prm R. W hh, AoWWO Er"*'o oaro+o, MOM, T. M0, 0. 000 M AuUtO'H E--XWO Owda POST OFFICE BOX 9 PALATKA, FLORIDA 32176-1429 SUNCCM 90yeea4m mt) 960SN."N Wo o>D W $60-MW uf 1A•Cfl ffP eoE rwXGWgua,SnsGuXP''1m o 419 ! aw0 a•.w isa sEp+•aw• WW Ila 309 Far anw 2133K NW+ A••• pr, d s•ana ar+ a,rO. stirs Moe" •. nrr• a:an• r eawr•. aeesa a ann• aum irr•"'a• G rp 407401r470 aD""'"° A auPal7CMg 40r(u1-1=a roe aW031)- aoo too .aPna+r• CONSOLIDATZD pRODUCTS, STEAK N SUM;, INC. 500 CKNTORY BVZLDINO 36 S. pSNNSVLVAN1A STREET INDIAKhpoLIS, IN 46204 suancT, management and Storage of Surface Waters General pervolt Number 40-117-0310 Dear Sir/Madam: o[ the St. is your general permit &a the staff ed JohnsaRiver Water Management DistrictthorLxed onAugusty28, 1995- and should be kept with your other ThisPermitisnlegaldocumentd Completion Report should be important documentsfice within thirty days after the filled The attache in and returned to the Palatka of you will enable us to schedule a work isCompleted. By so doing, prompt inspsetion of the pezloitted activity- lotionoxt, Your permit also cont in addition to the camp repains l of conditions which require submittaad0itncondltionetmust bell information submitted as compliance of submitted to the palatka office address. ve YOQ rom ty permit issuance done not re iefedQsalt ateeand/or localagencies of obtaining permits from Y asserting concurrent jurisdiction for this work. the event you sell your property, the pernnit will be In In the ed tothe new owner, if tie are notified by you within thirty days of the sales.?IorsthoIInow tus in his tter so. as propertyownor to maintain a valid permit pay owT. Marden,awar+ a,wria 0M Rosdh.T w1 01M - I I. Mconv, Yam S. 0iawoVA*O40MW1 M `"O M q ldNFshes n.Agum" hma+ T. Swvn I. 61 W Ifilllf Oom Ka f cl*"Gdft „pow Moses" 06VV- 6Z£-d06 :ON 131tjJW 11 WN3d NH01' 1S - Q I Z T : 60 Q311 S6 , -0£-9f lti 09/30/95 10:23 Q 003 I i i Thank you for your cooperation and if this office can be of any further assistance to .you, please do not hesitate to contact uo. Sincerely, MOA&'ha Marsha Baldwin, Data Control Technlotan Permit Data services Enclosureso Permit with completion Report Notice of Rights ccs District Files INT'ERFLAA PRACTICE, LTD ATT5 s yJaRIM McCOIG , F . 3 . 933 LSE ROAD, SUITS 120 0RLANDO, FL 32810 06"_6Z£-v06 :ON -a, d1W 1 I wd3d NHof 1S c a i ZT :60 a3M S6 OZ--9(ki 09/30/95 10:24 9 004 i aAMV paa,n, Care.,w. otr.e+ar torn R. Wat". A nbkw%f fu.aen.a•'a 0*006W OYat+o. chod a T. M"" 0.080%01 Ankomf eamuo + 32176-1429PALATy.KA T. POST OFFICE BOX 1420 F.L OR(I/D A g w iAD 9AfIDw IOK! larar TIAMm'a' fiEA1M'ft f>L apem sne.ro++ t+s>tKwr.tiAr MM VAR 00 ma..,a., f.Mfa aal a M7Qt+7r l ffilnE A' aff-mo no ,m00744100 Wo *Now— a7aM.a n0o '0170dyo foe Awn"-am PERMIT NO. 40-117-0310 DAT8 ISSUED August 20, 199S A pZRMIT AUTHORIZUMS CONSTRUCTidff AMD OPERATION OF A BURPACE WATER MMI&ASMENT SYSTEM FOR A 0.946 x = , STEAL N SHAME RESTAURANT DRAINING TO A PRgVIOUSLY PW%MITTBD MASTER SYSTEM. IochTIOg: section 29, TOWnahip 19 South, Range 30 East, asminole County ISSUED TOs CONSOLIDATED PRODUCTS. STEAL a 3.9"B' INC. Soo CXVTURY BUILDIM 36 S. PswNSYLVAMZA STREET INDIANhpMIs, IU 46204 permitted agrees to hold and save the St. Johne River "te" mar MM&ncl ant Diatrivt and its successors harmisas from anyiasand a. said es' appel& i=' or liabilities which stay &Kiss from p tce. S is by rdferen, includingall. plane and specifications attached steed a part hereot. This permit dodo not convey to permitted any property rights 'nor anY rights or privileges other than tlfoo• °ailationeorireguirementeve the Pam from ccoplyinQ with any low, reg affecting the rights of irNrhereuad r sbodi,00 or h l rsimainathell sproPertYeot the works installed by pesmi permitted. This Permit May be revoked, modified or transferred at any time pursuant to the appropriate provision• of Chapter 373, Florida statutees prRIQT IS CONDITIOUED OPM c see conditions on attached 'Exhibit A', dated August 28, 199S AUTHORIZED art at. Johno {tivar Water Kanagsmnt District Departmnt of Resource Management gave in d e By. . Bye ( AM 8 CRETARY) DZ ) LAMW DEAN JLFT RLLSDGs . 7 L am Rom, Otla w on, s.rn T. lS rrin.ar f Wtlsa gp l vKs awwrw Fddo n..+arM T. dmo w.r.aMM . a K tlgr C1iYfs11 awe QWP A6 obi ~ Janes H. dDuA a a oanaft smom cow rasnau 06yb_ 6ZZ_ y66 :0N -31 ti1W 1 I "dad NHOf IS a Q I £T :60 aw S6 0£-Cryd 09/30/95 10:25 9 005 ZXKIBIT A" CONDITIONS iOR ISSUANCE Op pB1WIT HVMBER 40-117-0310 CODISOLIDATZD PRODUCTS, STEM V SHAM INC. AUGUST 29, 199S 1. Prior to lot or unit sales, or upon Completion of construction of the system, whichever occurs first, the District must receive the final operation and maintenance decumsnt(s) approved by the District and recorded, if the latter is appvopr those systems which are proposed to be maintained by county or municipal entities, final operation and maintenance documents must be received by the District when maintenance and operation of the system Is accepted by -the local goverment entity. allure to submit the appropriate final document will result in the permittee remaining personally liable for carrying out maintenance and operation of the permitted system. 4. All construction, operation and maintenance shall be as set forth -in the plans, epacifications-and performance criteria an approved by this POrmit. 3_ District. authorised staff, upon proper identification. will have permiesion to enter, inspect and observe the system -to insure conformity with the plans and specifications approved by the permit. 4. The permittee must implement and maintain all erosion and sediment control measures (best management practices) required'to retain:sediment on -sits and to'prevent violations of the water quality criteria and standards in ObVtsre 17-4, 17-301, F.A.C. All practices must be in accordance with the guidelines and specifications in section 6 of the Florida Land Development Manuals A Guide to sound Land and pater Management (Florida Department of Environmental Regulation 1988) unlees a project -specific erosion and sediment control plan is approved as part of the permit in which ease this fPracticessite mustific be In ions accordance with the plan. require additional measures during any phase ofconstructionoroperationtoyreventerosionor control sediments beyond those specified in the erosion sediment control plan, the permittee must imp additional best management practices as necessary, in accordance with the specifications in section 6 of the Florida Land Development Manuals A Guide to sound Land and Water Management (Florida Dopartment of Rnvironmental Regulation, 19aa). S. Stabilisation measures shall be initiated for erosion and sediment control on disturbed areas so soon as practicable in portions of the site where construction U.LW l I WJ Bd N of 1S : Q 1 bi :60 a3M S6 ,-0£-9-b 09/30/95 10:25 0 006 activities have temporarily or permanently ceased, but in no case more than 14 days after the construction activity in that portion of the site has temporarily or permanently ceased. 6. The operation phase of the permit shall not become . sffsctive until a Florida registered profe**i0A41 Engineer certifies that the systen, or independent portion of a system, has been eonatructed in accordance with the permit issued by the District, and the permittee receives written notification by District staff that the construction, alteration, or maintenance has been complated.according to the permit. within 30 days after completion of construction of the surface water management system, or independent portion of the system, the permittee shall submit the certification or one net of plane which reflect the surface water management synem as actually constructed. Thin submittal shall ssrvs to notify the District that the system is ready for inspection. The permit may not be transferred to an operation and maintenance entity approved by the District until the operation phase or the permit becomes effective. 7. zf any other regulatory agency should require revision* or modification to the permitted project, the District is to be notified of the revisione so that a determination can be made whether a permit modification is required. 8. The District must be notified, in writing, within 30 days of any sale, conveyance, or other transfer -of a permitted system or faoilIty or within 30 days of any transfer of ownership or control of the real property at which the permitted. system or fsd,lity is loosted. All transfer* of a permit are' subject to the requirements of section 40C•-1.612, F.A.c. 9. she permittee must require the contractor to review and maintain a copy of this permit, complete with all conditions, attachments, exhibits, and modifications in good condition at the construction site. The complete permit shall be available for review upon request by District representatives. 10. construction or alteration of each phase or independent portion of the permitted surface water management system eyste ) must be completed in accordance with the permitted plans and permit conditions prior to the initiation of the permitted use of site infrastructure located within the area served by that portion or phase of the system. Each phase or independent portion of the system must be Complete in accordance with the permitted 09/30/95 10:26 Q 007 Plane and permit conditions prior to transfer of responsibility for operation and maintenance of that phase or portion of the system to local government or other responsible entity. 11. To the extent permitted by Florida law, the permittee must hold and save the District harmless from any and all liability arising from property damage or personal injury as a result of the permitted activities. 12. Nothing contained heroin relieves the permittee from timely complying with applicable laws or other federal, state, or. local governments. 13. If an entity other than.the permittee has been approved as the operation and maintenance entity, the permittee may request transfer of the permit for a completed system or independent portion of a system to the District approved operation and maintenancm entity at the time of submittal of the as -built@ or Professional Engineer certification for construction of the permitted surface water management system. 14. This permit for construction will expire five years from the date of issuance. 15. construction or alteration of the surface water management system must be completed and all disturbed areas must be stabilized in accordance with permitted plans and permit conditions prior to any of the following events (whichever occurs first)i issuance of a certificate of occupancy, use of the infra -structure for its intended use; or transfer of responsibility for operation and maintenance to a local government or other responsible entity. 16. All wetland areas or water bodies that are outside of the specific limits of construction authorized by this permit must be protected from ere@ion, siltation, scourinq or excess turbidity, and devatering. 17. Prior to construction, the permittee must clearly designate the limits of construction on-eite. The permittee must advise the contractor that any work outside the limits of construction, including clearing, is a violation of this permit. 18. The operation and maintenance entity shall submit inspection reports to this District two years after the operation phase permit becomes effective and ovary two years thereafter on District foss sN-46. The inspection form must be signed and sealed by an appropriate registered professional. 19. The proposed project must be constructed and operated in accordance with the plans received by the District on July 31, 1995, sheets Cl-C3, C-4 and L-l. 1.0d Z46a 06"-6Z£-VW:ON -al C1t1Q 1IWd3d NHOf 1S:0I ST:60 ail S6.-0£-9fki OCT 13 195 09:44 TO CITY OF SANFORD FROM Seminole County BCC T-589 P.E1 4/Q jak/ CVX T-tA- Jff-t, SEMINOLE COUNTY GOVERNMENT Comprehensive Planning 1101 East First Street Sanford, Florida 32771 DATE: October 13, 1995 Fax Cover Sheet TIME: 9:39 AM TO: Sybal Willamson PHONE: 407/330-5600 City of Sanford !FAX: 214/330-5666 FROM: Phyllis Wallac PHONE: 407/321-1130, ext. 7356 Seminole Coun FAX: 407/324-4818 RE: Steak and Shake Seminole County Impact Fee Refund. Per our conversation today, if you could refund Steak & Shake directly the $41,138.79 paid to the City, I would be very appreciative. This request is due to a calculation error on my part. I will take responsibility for contacting the applicant directly and making sure the correct amount is paid. Thanks for your assistance on this matter. Should you need any further information, please feel free to contact me. NUMBER OF PAGES INCLUDING COVER ONE (1). LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL Interplan Practice Ltd. c,ry gr SAS rnto 8- o c, PrPT, To NG Attention Architecture/Engineering/Interior Design AA-0001302 933 Lee Road, Ist Floor Orlando, Florida 32810 Telephone 407.645-5008 Fax 407.629-9124 I NTERPLAN P R A C T I C E 9390 Project No. J'. L9.pS Date We are sending via 33, 0 5-6G8 r ( Telephone syf! L n iccJt tJGiyll O l %Buln2 vt7/' Project V45A2 ", OaYtd vta s Subject Copies Sets Date Description Remarks ) G GiO K-IC— Kc-""S q 1' er ewpq-ram /z ay cc - DEstablishment Nome _ Mr. mw"sw Establishment location Ad*M red usn Owner Name ee., f c6 ?L.uy feu fV 47O Iiyiysrc f •p s a rTq o S. r oi;Z0 DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION Division of Hotels and Restau"""'lia:9 APPLICATION FOR -a "'°" e"„'` PLAN REVIEW -AIL 2 4 RECD 106NUMBER W 1 ?-5- sue/ DIV. Of HOTELS & RLSIAUkAWTS Please Print of type DISTRICT I i The applicant is to submit this cohipleted application with plans Redo FriellT IMuirriritluiii - , ; ° , o, P[New Construction Food service establishments closed` Conversion of existing Remodeling of existing food service structure to food service Noma of existing public food service etttashlishtrent,: , ,;; BPR license number of existing public food sanks.establlshinerit:j, U- GrzlG • Sa.nr{n'rL'i 3,271 G. Menu Information: Types of food involved and method of service. Attach a copy of proposed menu cawbrc rsu's_ •ffg , ft-r'b , n'.tnts aada Waste Water Disposal. Prior to the opening inspection, the applicant must provide written approval for waste water disposal from the appropriate agency MRS County Public Health Unit, Department of Environmental Protection, municipality or sewer district). Written ep• proval may be a copy of a permit or letter signed by the authority having juistfiction. Will your astablishement be served by: A. septic tank system? Yes ®No B. package sewer plant? Yes RNo C. municipallutility sewer? j8 Yes No If you answered YES to item B or C, complete the following: Name of municipallutility agsncy-5muine/e 4wmn f Size of groan troy: 7DOD gel. Location: Duft;de ! 2 PVyhd Water Supply. Prior to the opening inspection the applicant must provide written approval for a potable water supply from the appropriate agency MRS County Public Health Unit, Department of Environmental Protection, municipality or sewer district). Written approval may be a copy of a form or letter signed by the authority having jurisdiction. Will your establishment be served by: A. or site water well? Yes No B. municipallutility water? P9 Yes No h/! CAl It existing structure, provide deserlption lexampler steel warehouse, old wood from builft in historic district): Note: Construction finish schedules of floor, wells and ceiling must be provided on floor plans M Solid Waste Disposal. Type of Storage Container let 'A w'Orl-e x Waste water from cleaning containers disposed on site? Yes 'WNe 1111VAll establishment have an Alcoholic Beverage License? Yes of No If Yes, the establishment must meet all the sanitary retpriements of the state before the ' department staff may s'rm the application for beverage license. AN re"ad egmepnment and futures must be insteled and operating properly before approval car be Wren pursuant to s.561.17(2), Florida Statutes. 10Employser. Provide information on the anticipated umber and type of workers (such as: . kitchen workers, wait staff, cooks). The information should pro" the total raanber of workers, maximum per shift and hours of establishment. operation: Projected Service Capacity: Number of Seats ?7 OConstruction: Anticipated Start Completion / I LS M" an Tow moo Ow Tr Plans are rsvlewed on a fast•con•; first•nrvsd bash. Fbrids law slows 30 dsyr for kii. ii*; After plens us approved and construction Is comphte, pirsse contact * drl" district offlea far ainspectionIfyoudonotcurrentlyMidaBPRlicenseforthisastsblibmrt, submittal of as Applei tion for Liens mad the appropriate licann fin is roW d before the &Ai os will sciedda The opaimiq inspection If you answered YES to item B, complete the following: ololloer Name of municipallutility agency 01h, SQ,r„ red _YA E % 123 19S il SIGNATURE OF APPLICANT MONTH DAY YEAR The plan reviewer will notify the responsiblelagent when the plan review is completed LOG NUMBER)IX! - 9534 DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS REGULATION DIVISION OF HOTELS AND RESTAURANTS SPECIFICATION WORKSHEET OFFICE USE ONLY 1. Establishment Name: 3+eflil ATTACH TO APPLICATION 2. Type Review: New stablishment: () Extensively Remodeled () Remodeled ffNew Construction greater thin 50% asiaied value 50% assessed value or less Conversion Closed for 3 or more years 3. Construction Finishes: Floor* Wall Ceiling Food Prep All Agras mu!,,r v tbS Food Storage AA, 12 CA SrL.4 cLe7 Ard A4 Lc - Wash Area Rest Rooms Covering materials: A4,V S r r3 6- Srw6D'Ttit Lkie_ PMy ieus a Ehs to y e LewN,*aie Key: S - Satisfactory U - Unsatisfactory' NA - Not Applicable C - Caution (information inadequate or potential operational violation, will be checked during inspections) 4. C, Floors graded to floor drains 5. _ C., No unnecessarily exposed utility lines, pipes on floors 6. _( L No exposed studs, joists, rafters allowed in walk-ins, food preparation, dish washing areas or toilet rooms. If exposed in other areas, they must be cleanable 7. -- C,— Wall panels, coverings closed at joints, sealed to wall and ceiling 8. Comments: DBR 21-011 Page I of 4 Rev. 11-24-92 LOG NUMBER Sinks/Dishmachines 9. Sanitizing facilities provided when potentially hazardous food prepared and/or customer dishes re -used: (,) 3 compartment sink ()O:dishmachine 10. _ Sinks with drain boards (or equiv.), backsplash, self -draining No. shown: s8- 4, _1 39 _:ft= 2 compartments 11. _ Adequate facilities to air dry dishware, utensils, equipment 12. _C Adequate facilities to store cleaned and soiled utensils, equipment 13. s_ One compartment food prep sinks. No. shown ...i 14. S Hand sink(s) in food prep area(s). No.'shown I- 15. S_ Hand sink in remote mechanical dishwash area 16. _S_ Mop wash facility, located: &,1t t y 17. _ c- Hot and cold water supplied to all sinks where required 18. _ C Compartments sized to accommodate equipment 19. Dishmachine Model 20. Chemical 1800 1650 _ booster 21. Comments: Fire Safety 22. C Automatic, portable extinguishing equipment provided as needed 23. S_ Means of egress 24. _ L- Gas appliances 25. Comments: KA,, sT =e ter G 02 % a C-0 c H c F(vc Aut-W T-Y Equipments Instollation/Design 26. c Ice produced and stored in protected area 27. _. Displayed food protected 28. _` Running water dipper well for bulk ice cream service 29. c Beverage tubing installed properly 30. S_ Adequate storage facilities (dry & refrigerated) 31. _ c- Open shelving to be at least 6" above floor 32. c Equipment designed to facilitate cleaning, e.g., no raw wood, pegboard, contact paper 33. C Equipment installed to facilitate cleaning, e.g., easily cleaned beneath, behind, between 34. _ r Tabletop equipment, not easily movable, not sealed shall be on legs at least 4" high 35. _ C Floor mounted equipment, not easily movable, not sealed shall be on raised platforms or on legs at least 6" high 36. ' C Designated area for employee belongings 37. C Laundry facilities properly located 38. _ C Adequate storage area for maintenance and cleaning equipment 39. Comments: Lighting 40. _ r Adequate lighting provided. Minimum 20 ft-c on working surfaces, 10 ft-c on other surfaces 41. C_ Lights shielded, coated, covered where food stored, prepared, displayed where food is open or exposed DBR 21-011 Page 2 of 4 Rev. 11-24-92 LOU NUMBER Ventilation 42. — All rooms and equipment that produce appreciable quantity of steam, obnoxious odors, fumes, vapors, grease, smoke to be vented to outside43. _r Intake and exhaust air ducts properly designed and installed Premises 44. C_ Walking and driving surfaces shall be constructed to minimize dust and graded topreventpoolingofwater 45. r,_ Doors to exterior self -closing, open outward Plumbing 46. _L Backsiphonage and backflow protection if no air gap/break47. C Faucets with hose fitting to have backflow protection device48. r Refrigeration waste piping shall discharge indirectly into floor drain or receptor approved by local plumbing authority. 49. ' C Food contact surfaces shall not be placed under exposed sewer lines. 50. Location of hot water heater(s) 51, Rest rooms: Rest rooms Public Males WC Urin. Females WC I . Lay. 52. C Hot and cold water to all lavatories used by employees53. _C Rest rooms vented or provided with windows to outside54. _' Doors to be self -closing 55. _$_ Rest rooms accessible by customers without going through food preparation areas56. The plumbing standard is: So. Stand. So. Fl, Inn -In r~eV Other (specify) - -- -- - - - 57. Comments: 58. G Waste container, grease receptacle, compactor on smooth non-gbsorbent surface59. _r. Compactor area drained to sanitary sewer60. _C Wastewater from cleaning of containers drained to sanitary sewer61. Comments: _ Y,„. , I DBR 21-011 Page 3 of 4 Rev. 11-24-92 lop LOG NUMBER V*ater Supply 62. Type of Supply; Municipal/Utility . On -Site well Other 63. Name of Supplier _ Ci rt „ .F C,,,,. , . 64. Written approval for use issued by P rsvidm J p/ 65. Public Well Permit No. 66. Comments: Waste Water Disposal 67. Type of System: Municipal/Utility X_ Pkg.Plant OSDS68. Written approval for use issued by PjqA ne p m,4e_4_ 69. Name of System _ cpA",,; yuI 70.OSDS Permit No: Tank Size _ gal. Drainfield sq.ft. 71. Grease Trap _ 4 n n gal. Location of grease trap72. Comments: Seating Capacity 73. Maximum seating capacity as designated on the plans _ Q q 74. Plans Approved with noted provisos to be corrected Plans Denied RESUBMIT corrected plans as indicated. 75. Comments: All Items Will Be Verified During Construction And Opening Inspections. Establishment is to meet all standards of Chapter 509, F.S., and Chapter 7•C, F.A.C. Plans Reviewed by Applicant Signature Date _ ?1_ - 7 -9 5— Date S /U // 9 5 U Print Name) J O 5 Q h 1 1 S r) (yell) DBR 21-011 Page 4 of 4 Rev. l 1-24-92 Whole Building Performance Method for Commercial Buildings Farm 40OA-94 ENERGY EFFICIENCY CODE FOR BUILDING CONSTRUCTION Florida Department of Community Affairs FLA/COM-94 Version 2.1A PROJECT NAME Steak IN Shake Restaurant__ PERMITTING OFFICE: ADDRESS: Seminole Towne Center Sanford Sanford Florida ........... CLIMATE ZONE: 5 __ OWNER: Stead: IN Shake Corporation_ PERMIT NO: _ 35011 g AGENT: JURISDICTION NO: 691500 BUILDING TYPE: Restaurant ? 100 Peep CONSTRUCTION CONDITION: New construct DESIGN COMPLETION: _Finished Building CONDITIONED FLOOR AREA: _3391________ MAX. TONNAGE OF EQUIPMENT PER SYSTEM: COMPLIANCE CALCULATION: METHOD A A. WHOLE BUILDING PRESCRIPTIVE REQUIREMENTS: LIGHTING le ion NUMBER OF ZONES: 1 34 DESIGN CRITERIA RESULT 51 . 18 100.00 PASSES EXTERIOR LIGHTING 150.00 175.00 PASSES LIGHTING CONTROL REQUIREMENTS PASSES HVAC EQUIPMENT' COOLING EQUIPMENT 1. EER 8.90 8.54 PASSES IPLV 9.45 7.50 PASSES HEATING EQUIPMENT 1. Et 1.00 N/A AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM INSULATION LEVEL 1. With Insulated Roof 6.00 6.00 PASSES WATER HEATING EQUIPMENT 1. EF 3.00 0.77 PASSES PIPING INSULATION REQUIREMENTS 1. Non -Circulating w/o H 1.00 1.00 PASSES COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION: I hereby certify that the plans and specifications covered by this calcu- lation are in compliance with the Florida Energy VON Cede. PREPARED BY: VON Axn- DATE:----zZVO K I hereby certify that this building is in complianMwiFlorida Energy Efficiency OWNER/AGENT• DATE.-------------- Review of the plans and specifica- tions covered by this calculation indicates compliance with the Florida Energy Efficiency Code. Before construction is completed, this building will be inspected for compliance in accordance with Section 553. 908, Fly r ' da Statutes BUILDING OFF0-- L-•/_ ij1 pJ Statutes DATE: 5/ _mil_ I hereby certify(*) that the system desiian is in compliance with the Florida Energy Efficiency Cade. SYSTEM DESIGNER REGISTRATION/STATE ARCHITECT : MECHANICAL: _A LBER T_F_A/VE /36 /4 FL oR I DA________ PLUMBING ELECTRICAL• LIGHTING Signature is required where Florida :law requires design to be performed by registered design professionals. Typed names and registration numbers may be used where all relevant information is contained can signed/sealed plans. BUILDING INFORMATION COMPLIANCE CHECK 401------- GLAZING --ZONE 1------------------------------------------------ v- Elevation Type U Sc VLT Shading Area(Sgft): East Commercial 0.55 0.71 0.6 Continuous Ove 200: South Commercial 0.55 0.71 0.6 Continuous Ove 204: West Commercial 0.55 0.71 0.6 Continuous Ove 47 Total Glass Area in Zone 1 = 451 Total Glass Area = 4511 402------- WALLS --ZONE 1------------------------------------------------ f--- Elevation Type U Added R Gross(Sgft): North Frame, R-19, Finish. 0.05 0 640: East Frame, R-19, Finish. 0.05 C) 12241 South Frame, R-15, Finish. 0.05 8241' West Frame, R-19, Finish. 0.05 0 1056 Total Wall Area in Zone 1 = 37441 Total Gross Wall Area = 3744 403------- DOORS --ZONE 1------------------------------------------------ i--- Elevation Type U Area(Sgft) North 1-3/4 Wood Door -Solid core flush 0.40 241 East 1-3/4 Wood Door -Solid core flush 0.40 34; Total Door Area in Zone 1 = 47 Total Door Area = 47 404------- ROOFS --ZONE 1------------------------------------------------ i--- Type Color U Added R Area(Sgft) l Memb,.75" Seathing, R-30 Medium 0.03 0 3630 Total Roof f Area in Zone 1 = 36301 Total Roof Area = 3630: 405------- FLOORS -ZONE 1------------------------------------------------ f--- Type R Area(Sgft){ Slab on Grade/Uninsulated 0 3630: Total Floor Area in Zone 1 = 3630 Total Floor Area = 3630 406.------INFILTRATION -------------------------------------------------- 1--- CHECK Infiltration Criteria in 406.1.ABC.1 have been met. v 1 407------- COOLING SYSTEMS ----------------------------------------------- : --- Type No Efficiency IPLV Tens! 1. Air Cooled ( '= 65,000 Btu/h 4 8.9 9.45 33.78.' 408------- HEATING SYSTEMS ----------------------------------------------- : --- Type No Efficiency BTU/hr: i 1. Electric Resistance 4 1.00 163824: 405------- VENTILATION --------------------------------------------------- :--- CHECK: Ventilation Criteria in 409.1.ABC.1 have been met. v 1 410------ AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM ---------------------------------------- 1--- AHU Type Duct Location R-value: 1. Packaged Constant Volume With Insulated Roof 6.0! 411------ PUMPS AND PIPING -ZONE 1---------------------------------------:--- Type R-value/in Diameter Thickness; 1. Non -Circulating w/o Heat 4 1.25 1 412------ WATER HEATING SYSTEMS -ZONE 1----------------------------------;--- Type Efficiency StandbyLoss InputRate Gallons; 1. <; =12 kW 3.0 0.02 3.7 120 : 413------ ELECTRICAL POWER DISTRIBUTION --•-------------------------------- ; CHECK Metering criteria in 413.1.ABC.1 have been met. ; li ; Transformer criteria in 413.1.ABC.2 have been met. ; (j ; 414.-----MOTORS----------------------------------------------------;---- --- Motor efficiencies in 414.1.ABC.1 have been met. ; !/ 415.-----LIGHTING SYSTEMS -ZONE 1 --------------------------------------- Space Type No Control Type i No Control Type 2 No Watts Area(Sgft) Leisure Di 1 On/Off 6 0 6102 3391 Total Watts for Zone i = 6102: Total Area for Zone 1 = 3391: Total Watts = 6102: Total Area = 3391 CHECK Lighting criteria in 415.1.ABC have been met. 16. HVAC load sizing has been performed. (407.1.ABC.1) ; v 17. Duct sizing and design have been performed. (410.1.ABC.1.2) ; v ; 18. Testing and balancing will be performed. (410.1.ABC.4j 19. Operation/maintenance manual will be provided to owner. (102. 1) ; !/ S T C A K l /v s- H,91 E 7/7/ 95 DESIGN DATA FOR SANFORD LATITUDE : 28 ELEVATION (FEET) 89 WINTER DESIGN TEMP 35 SUMMER DESIGN DP : 94 SUMMER DESIGN WEB : 76 DAILY RANGE : 17 STEAK. IN SHADE DINING 07 -07 -1 SS5 SANFORD FLORIDA LAT 28 ALT = 89 CONST= 70W/40R/ 70B ID= 76/52 72 WALL COLOR: MEDIUM ROOF COLOR: MEDIUM 60515841.6 D.B.TEMP TOTAL TONS RSH TONS C.F.M. 1. JUN AT 9 A.M. 82. 2 11.84 5.69 2,955 2. JUL AT 9 A.M. 83. 2 11.96 5.79 3,006 3. OCT AT to A.M. 79. 8 10.72 5.78 3, 000 4. DEC AT 2 P.M. 79.8 10.40 6.06 3,148 5. SEP AT 3 P.M. 92.0 12.49 5.69 2,958 6. AUG AT 4 P.M. 93. 0 13.11 5.82 3, o2l 7. JUN AT 4 P.M. 93. 0 12.84 5.59 2,905 ZONE HEATING--:: 14,764 W/INFIL= 14,764 C.F.M 746 INPUTS CEILING PARTITION TRANSMISSION FACT. 0.00 0.00 TEMP DIFF HEATING 0 0 TEMP DIFF COOLING 0 0 FLOURESCENT LIGHTS - N SOLAR FACTOR OVERHANGS AND/OR REVEALS HEIGHT OF OVERHANG DEPTH OF OVERHANG HEIGHT OF WINDOW DEPTH OF REVEAL NUMBER FLOORS TYPE 1 1.0 i 3. 00 5. 50 0. 00 1.00 EFFECTIVE AVERAGES FOR ZONE LOAD EXPOSURE: N. NE E. WALL TRANS. FACTORS 0.00 0.00 0.05 GLASS TRANS FACTORS 0.00 0.00 0.55 GLASS SOLAR FACTORS 0.00 0.00 0.63 ROOF TRANS. FACTOR = 0.03 Sk;YL I NUMBER OF PEOPLE _ TOTAL LIGHTS = OTHER ELECTRICAL = E. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= S. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= W. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= W. TYPE 1SHADE AREA = TOTAL GLASS AREA = TOTAL GLASS AREA = SKYLIGHT AREA = SKYLIGHT AREA = FLOOR SKYLIGHT 0 37 0 17 SKYLIGHT 0.00 PRESENT FT) TYPE 2 TYPE 3 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0. 00 1.00 1.00 S OR OP -COST: SE S. SW W. NW 0.00 0.05 0.00 0.05 0.00 O.Oo 0.55 0.00 0.55 0.00 0.00 0.63 0. 00, 0.63 0.00 3HT TRANS. FACTOR = 0.00 OUTPUTS 105 SENSIBLE PEOPLE LOAD = 29,400 2,370 LIGHTING LOAD = 8,089 0 OTHER ELECTRICAL = 0 200 E. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 3,295 204 S. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 2,942 27 W. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 1,951 4 W. TYPE 1 SHADE SOLAR = 32 431 TOTAL GLASS SOLAR = 8,220 431 TOTAL GLASS TRANS. = 4,030 0 TOTAL SKYLIGHT SOLAR = 0 0 TOTAL SKYLIGHT TRANS = 0 E. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 512 E. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 433 S. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 524 S. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 588 W. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 101 W. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 121 TOTAL WALL AREA = 1,137 TOTAL WALL TRANS. 1,142 PARTITION AREA = 0 TOTAL PART. TRANS 0 CEILING AREA = 0 TOTAL CEILING TRANS 0 FLOOR AREA = 0 TOTAL FLOOR TRANS Ci AREA OF ROOF = 1,580 ROOF LOAD 1,762 SAFETY FACTOR = 3% SAFETY B.T.U.S 2,033 EVAP FAN H.P. _ 0.87 FAN HEAT GAIN - DT 2,653 MISC SENSIBLE = 15,116 MISC. SENSIBLE 15,116 VENTILATION CFM = 1,304 0. A.SENSIBLE LOAD 24,385 MISC. LATENT = 0 MISC. LATENT 0 NUMBER OF PEOPLE = 105 PEOPLE LATENT LOAD 26,350 VENTILATION CFM = 1,304 O.A. LATENT LOAD 32,122 TOTAL CFM-STDAIR = 3,021 TOTAL LATENT LOAD 60,472 ROOM SENSIBLE = 69,790 ROOM LAT. LOAD 28,350 STEAK IN SHAKE DINING GRAND TOTAL LOAD = 157,300 BTU'S OR 13.11 TONS <:.-- LOAD RUN FOR # 6. AUG AT 4 P.M. - AREA ( SO FT) = 1,580 SO. FT PER TON = 121 TOTAL CFM-STD AIR = 3,021 CFM PER SO FT = 1.91 HEATING LOAD PARTITION LOAD CEILING LOAD = 0 VENTILATION LOAD = 53,073 ROOF HEATING LOAD = 1,754 FLOOR HEATING LOAD= 0 SKYLIGHT LOAD = 0 GLASS HEATING LOAD= 8,771 WALL HEATING LOAD = 2,103 SLAB HEATING LOAD =2,136 INFIL HEAT LOAD = 0 WARM UP LOAD = 0 H LOAD WITH VENT = 67,837 COIL SELECTION PARAMETERS DB TEMP ENT/LVG = 83.3 54.2 TOT SENSIBLE LOAD = 36,82B WB TEMP ENT/LVG = 69.9 53.4 TOTAL COIL LOAD = 157,300 SPECIFIED ROOM RH = 52% RESULTING ROOM RH = 54% TERM AIR TEMP = 55.00 90 DEGREES ROTATED = 0 T. ST. EVAP FAN = 1.00 NON -CEILING RETURN BLDG. 'U' FACTOR= 0.11 CARRIER DEFAULTS STEAK IN SHAKE KITCHEN ci 7 -07 -1995 SANFORD FLORIDA LAT 28 ALT = 89 CONST= 70W/40R/ 70B ID= 76/52 72 WALL COLOR: MEDIUM ROOF COLOR: MEDIUM 60515841.6 D.B.TEMP TOTAL TONS RSH TONS C.F.M. 1. JUN AT 9 A.M. 82.2 11.66 5.66 2,942 2. JUL AT 9 A.M. 83.2 11.68 5.68 2,950 3. OCT AT 10 A.M. 79. 8 10.23 5.5E 2,888 4. DEC AT 2 P.M. 79. 8 9.51 5.55 2,881 5. SEP AT 3 P.M. 92.0 12.60 5.88 3,053 G. AUG AT 4 P.M. 93. 0 13.24 6.00 3,115 7. JUN AT 4 P.M. 92. 0 131.23 5.99 3,109 ZONE HEATING--' 10,046 W/ INFI L = 10, 04G C.F. M 507 INPUTS CEILING PARTITION TRANSMISSION FACT. (--).00 0.00 TEMP DIFF HEATING 0 0 TEMP DIFF COOLING C) 0 FLOURESCENT LIGHTS - Y SOLAR FACTOR OVERHANGS AND/OR REVEALS HEIGHT OF OVERHANG DEPTH OF OVERHANG HEIGHT OF WINDOW DEPTH OF REVEAL NUMBER FLOORS TYPE 1 1.0 3.00 5. 50 0. 00 1.00 FLOOR SKYLIGHT i)i) 0. oo 0 37 0 17 SKYLIGHT 0.00 PRESENT FT) TYPE 2 TYPE 3 0. 00 0.00 0. 00 0. 00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.00 1.00 EFFECTIVE AVERAGES FOR ZONE LOADS OR OP -COST: EXPOSURE: N. NE E. SE S. SW W. NW WALL TRANS. FACTORS 0.05 0.00 0.05 0.00 0.05 0.00 0.05 0.00 GLASS TRANS FACTORS 0.55 o. c_ 0 0.55 0.00 o. 00 0.00 0. 55 0. o0 GLASS SOLAR FACTORS 0.63 0.00 0.63 0.00 O.Oo 0.00, 0.63 0.00 ROOF TRANS. FACTOR = 0.03 SKYLIGHT TRANS. FACTOR = 0.00 NUMBER OF PEOPLE _ TOTAL LIGHTS = OTHER ELECTRICAL = N. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= E. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= W. TYPE 1 GLASS AREA= W. TYPE 1SHADE AREA = TOTAL GLASS AREA = TOTAL GLASS AREA = SKYLIGHT AREA = SKYLIGHT AREA = OUTPUTS 16 SENSIBLE PEOPLE LOAD = 4,48o 2,717 LIGHTING LOAD = 11,589 0 OTHER ELECTRICAL = i 24 N. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 176 24 E. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 395 20 W. TYPE 1 GLASS SOLAR = 1,445 3 W. TYPE 1 SHADE SOLAR = 24 68 TOTAL GLASS SOLAR = 2,040 68 TOTAL GLASS TRANS. = 636 0 TOTAL SKYLIGHT SOLAR = 0 0 TOTAL SKYLIGHT TRANS = 0 N. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 616 N. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 400 E. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 488 E. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 413 S. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 96 S. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 108 W. TYPE 1 WALL AREA = 908 W. TYPE 1 WALL LOAD 1,089 TOTAL WALL AREA = 108 TOTAL WALL TRANS. 2,010 PARTITION AREA = 0 TOTAL PART. TRANS C) CEILING AREA = 0 TOTAL CEILING TRANS 0 FLOOR AREA = C-) TOTAL FLOOR TRANS 0 AREA OF ROOF = 1,811 ROOF LOAD 3,019 SAFETY FACTOR = 3% SAFETY B.T.U.S 2,096 EVAP FAN H.P. = 0.89 FAN HEAT GAIN - DT 3,735 MISC SENSIBLE = 47,o,95 MISC. SENSIBLE 47,095 VENTILATION CFM = 1,392 0. A.SENSIBLE LOAD 26,030 MISC. LATENT = 15,250 MISC. LATENT 15,250 NUMBER OF PEOPLE = 16 PEOPLE LATENT LOAD 4,320 VENTILATION CFM = 1,392 O.A. LATENT LOAD 38,637 TOTAL CFM-STDAIR = 3,115 TOTAL LATENT LOAD 58,207 ROOM SENSIBLE = 71,965 ROOM LAT. LOAD 19,570 STEAK. IN SHAKE KITCHEN GRAND TOTAL LOAD = 158,937 BTU'S OR 13.24 TONS ;-- LOAD RUN FOR # 6. AUG AT 4 P.M. AREA (SO FT) = 1,811 SCE. FT PER TON = 137 TOTAL CFM-STD AIR = 3,115 CFM PER SLR FT = 1.72 HEATING LOAD PARTITION LOAD = 0 CEILING LOAD = C) VENTILATION LOAD = 56,654 ROOF HEATING LOAD = 2,010 FLOOR HEATING LOAD= 0 SKYLIGHT LOAD = 0 GLASS HEATING LOAD= 1,384 WALL HEATING LOAD = 3,900 SLAB HEATING LOAD = 2,752 INFIL HEAT LOAD = 0 WARM UP LOAD = 0 H LOAD WITH VENT = 66,700 COIL SELECTION PARAMETERS DB TEMP ENT/LVG = 83.6 54.2 TOT SENSIBLE LOAD = 100,73o WB TEMP ENT/LVG = 69.6 53.3 TOTAL COIL LOAD = 158,937 SPECIFIED ROOM RH = 52% RESULTING ROOM RH = 50% TERM AIR TEMP = 55.00 90 DEGREES ROTATED = 0 T. ST. EVAP FAN = 1.00 NON -CEILING RETURN BLDG. 'U' FACTOR= 0.05 CARRIER DEFAULTS N CITY OF SANFORD, FLORIDA APPLICATION FOR BUILDING PERMIT Lit) fv i PERMIT ADDRESS Se Towne center c1 r'cle PERMIT NUMBER Total Contract Price of Job A3091000 moftl Total Sq. Ft. 30 630Sr Describe work AleAq eonbtruetron 7Cpr et S K&At In ShaJc4 K ara.rit Type of. Construction %G $ unD #Ttecred Flood Prone (YES) Number of Stories pyE Number of Dwellings NA Zoning P /) Occupancy: Residential ,y4 Commercial A — 2 Industrial ,yq LEGAL DESCRIPTION (please attach printout from Seminole County) TAX I.D. NUMBER 29-/9- 3o— ri•Lk/— 060o — 000a OWNER ADDRESS LOnse/"drtted AbdUC13 /6teaA'nSltaktTilc. SDD Cthfu/'y Build i 1 36 S. fej*nSy/ya,7ni; PHONE NUMBER (og3-y/06 CITY rmdiit,4ARo1i.S STATE rn/ ZIP l/ 6u f TITLE HOLDER ADDRESS CITY IF OTHER THAN OWNER) SAMgr /,s LiwAIE2 6i1Le OE-uo44 BONDING COMPANY ADDRESS CITY ARCHITECT BE ADDRESS 5/o 04 STATE STATE CITY-rnd1'&A&P0/i5 STATE MORTGAGE ADDRESS CITY LENDER STATE ZIP ZIP ZIP 5162Z7 ZIP CONTRACTOR vI--,I/J ' PHONE NUMBER Oi4 ADDRESS lor 2nn 11 -f j4o ST. LICENSE NUMBER (o CITY /A i II Y.41 u STATE 7 i ZIP ':?,;7- (v Application is hereby made to obtain a permit to do the work and installations as indicated. I certify that no work or installation has commenced prior to the issuance of a permit and that all work will be performed to meet standards of all laws regulating construction in this jurisdiction. I understand that a separate permit must be secured for ELECTRICAL, PLUMBING, MECHANICAL, SIGNS, POOLS, ETC. OWNER'S AFFIDAVIT: I certify that all the f.orecloing information is accurate and that all work will be done in compliance with all applicable laws regulating construction and zoning. A COPY OF THE RECORDED COPY OF THE; NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT WILL BE POSTED ON THE JOB SITE WITH PERMITS NO LATER THAN SEVEN (7) DAYS AFTER THE PERMIT HAS BEEN ISSUED. FAILURE TO RECORD A NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT MAY RESULT IN YOU PAYING TWICE FOR THE IMPROVEMENTS TO YOUR PROPERTY. IF YOU INTEND TO OBTAIN FINANCING, CONSULT WITH YOUR LENDER OR AN ATTORNEY BEFORE RECORDING YOUR NOTICE OF COMMENCEMENT. NOTICE: In addition to the requirements of this: permit, there may be additional restrictions applicable to this property that may be found in the public records of this county, and there may be additional permits required from other governmental entities such as water management districts, state agencies, or federal agencies. ACCEPTANCE OF P RMIT IS THE REQUIRE N. / FLO VERIFICATION THAT I WILL NOTIFY THE OWNER OF THE PROPERTY OF u^F A INN LAW, FS713. f•** ********************************** 13 '0z co 0 UGti7 Zj m o Owner/Agent & Dat Sienature of Contractor & Date 0 VZ4of E. E s_sG lBEN z Type or Pr nt Owner/Agent Name Typ Print Con a is Name o x 3 J3- 7 0 D ro n Notary & DateiaureofNotary & Date Signature rt nyi CASTO MARY L. SE I MY COMMISSION 8 CC: 36 : g ' "yap': A4Y COMMISSION B CC 470040 EXPIRES: May 16. 1998 plplpES: August 4, 'IN9 0 BmM Thru Nmjy Pubk Underarlters . r,. a ` Thru Notary PuI)BC U05-'"t- ro Application Ape/t ved BY: Date: /"`,-' FEES: Building ( Radon PolicJA Fire -60 Open Space Road Impact pli ationPERMITVALIDATION: CHECK CASH DATE_ BY ORIGINAL (BUILDING) YELLOW (CUSTOMER) PINK (COUNTY TAX OFFICE) GOLD (CO. ADMIN) THIS APPLICATION USED FOR WORK VALUED $2500.00 OR MORE June 21, 1995 To Whom It May Concern: A Consolidated Products Company Ste'M. h.nShake"` Inc. 500 Century Building 36 South Pennsylvania Street Indianapolis, IN 46204 317) 633-4100 This letter shall serve as official authorization for any representative of Interplan Practice, Ltd., to act as our agent and to make permit application on our behalf for the project listed below: Seminole Towne Center Lot LL-04 Sanford, Florida Corporate Seal STATE OF INDIANA SS: COUNTY OF MARION Authorized Representative: STEAK N SHAKE, INC. Cheryl J. Wendling Corporate Secretary By: Before me, the undersigned, a Notary:Public in and for said County and State, this 21th day of June, 1995, personally appeared Cheryl J. Wendling, Corporate Secretary of Steak n Shake, Inc., an Indiana corporation, and acknowledge the execution of foregoing document. tary Public My Commission Expires: County of Residence: o- r arc 29-19-30-5LW-0600-0000 name SEMINOLE TOWNE CENTER LP addl C/O MELVIN SIMON & ASSOC INC add2 P 0 BOX 7033 csz INDIANAPOLIS, IN 46207 pad CURRENT 95 DELETED date 07/18/95 nbad 1.00 act own % td dor flg -- pre/late -- -- exemptions -- 52 10 0 - jval land 897,860 agrc extra feat bldg cost value 897,860 income total just value 897,860 exmp-amt yr tax due 1900 20,482.98 e&i 1 50 LEGAL LEG TRACT 6 SEMINOLE TOWNE CENTER REPLAT PB 47 PGS 8 THRU 10 INFO: DELETED NOW IN PB 49 PG 27 SALES land 08 04/19/94 bldg 01/01/00 chg NOR 05/19/95 Note, Legal, Sale, Bld/land/xf, Amd10,H:ist,Other Tax Roll,Fwd,Main Menu, [EXIT] FRM-40505:ORACLE error -- unable to perform query. Count: *0 ( Replace> LETTER OF TRANSAUTTAI. Interplan Practice Ltd. ArchitecturelEngineeringlhtterior Design AA-CO01302 933 Lee Road, I st Floor Orlando, Florida 32810 Telephone 407.645-5008 Fax 407.629-9124 INTERPLAN P R A C T I C E CITY of SA-MGORD F//Z-C- DtPT 141390 To Project No. 301 Cewiw Arlo Drive 7.25.95 Date anfDrd `L 3 Z77/ //AAJO Oe4MER We are sending via jelCHA-!ZA2 GOH6A/ V07 3 2 - Of(of Attention Telephone 5AeA4e 'it 5hakc Sewino/G Towne 6e4Ye.,- Project A/a n feyiems/ Ju bmissl ;w Subject Date Description dui/dii?9 Plans kb i% d)'rtern.tiona/ sift old. e%4la417or/ P.NGr4V P/ans . Leh'w o/ &m SfW4 i7 Shake f0 "-f a5 we. Remarks 1f- IS In unAZt yotc w/7/ {arward Elie 4,faehtom/ e/ ano 710 JhG Bu/W-,4 &gegtrt"77eyrt kQbeot yoAer "tvics i'S co.,,v/efed. 5hou/ d you hgwe- any 9.yes756ns e,- 1-e9vive a.dd'f70ra./ in r,Ia ror,, L2le45e , qe/ free 71p een7`a.c21' ene . T %/ hw- hQe4y assist i• an y way eossib/e . Thank. you . A- Mmte Add O renq- . Sftak Shake DAV-LIN CONSTRUCTION CO., INC.. P.O. BOX 24748 JACKSONVILLE, FLORIDA 32241 August 22, 1995 City of Sanford Building and Zoning Department P.O. Box 1788 Sanford, FL 32772 407) 330-5644 Re: Steak N Shake Seminole Town Center Sanford, F1 TO WHOM IT MAY CONCERN: 904) 260.2461/FAX (904) 260-1492 Please accept this letter for Mr. Mark Emerson acting on my behalf to pick and sign for any permits and/or any other documents necessary for the above referenced project. Thank you for your cooperation in this matter. Sincerely, Davi L. 7ecisVcePrey Florida License # CGC034236 DLS: ld Sworn and described before me this 22 day of August 1995. 6l' ii1 71 U" Print Name: Leslie A. Deason Notary Public, State of Florida Personally Known X or Produced Identification Type of Identification Produced:_ My commission expires: LESLIE A. DEASON NOTARY PUBLIC, STATE OF FLORIDA My commission expires June 28, 1998 Commission No. CC 388447